2009-01-19 Iain Sandoe <iain.sandoe@sandoe-acoustics.co.uk>
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / reload1.c
blobbbffad0b98dc4a0d5081a8104168222e91d2dae1
1 /* Reload pseudo regs into hard regs for insns that require hard regs.
2 Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
3 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6 This file is part of GCC.
8 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
9 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
10 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
11 version.
13 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
14 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
15 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
16 for more details.
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
20 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24 #include "coretypes.h"
25 #include "tm.h"
27 #include "machmode.h"
28 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
29 #include "rtl.h"
30 #include "tm_p.h"
31 #include "obstack.h"
32 #include "insn-config.h"
33 #include "flags.h"
34 #include "function.h"
35 #include "expr.h"
36 #include "optabs.h"
37 #include "regs.h"
38 #include "addresses.h"
39 #include "basic-block.h"
40 #include "reload.h"
41 #include "recog.h"
42 #include "output.h"
43 #include "real.h"
44 #include "toplev.h"
45 #include "except.h"
46 #include "tree.h"
47 #include "ira.h"
48 #include "df.h"
49 #include "target.h"
50 #include "emit-rtl.h"
52 /* This file contains the reload pass of the compiler, which is
53 run after register allocation has been done. It checks that
54 each insn is valid (operands required to be in registers really
55 are in registers of the proper class) and fixes up invalid ones
56 by copying values temporarily into registers for the insns
57 that need them.
59 The results of register allocation are described by the vector
60 reg_renumber; the insns still contain pseudo regs, but reg_renumber
61 can be used to find which hard reg, if any, a pseudo reg is in.
63 The technique we always use is to free up a few hard regs that are
64 called ``reload regs'', and for each place where a pseudo reg
65 must be in a hard reg, copy it temporarily into one of the reload regs.
67 Reload regs are allocated locally for every instruction that needs
68 reloads. When there are pseudos which are allocated to a register that
69 has been chosen as a reload reg, such pseudos must be ``spilled''.
70 This means that they go to other hard regs, or to stack slots if no other
71 available hard regs can be found. Spilling can invalidate more
72 insns, requiring additional need for reloads, so we must keep checking
73 until the process stabilizes.
75 For machines with different classes of registers, we must keep track
76 of the register class needed for each reload, and make sure that
77 we allocate enough reload registers of each class.
79 The file reload.c contains the code that checks one insn for
80 validity and reports the reloads that it needs. This file
81 is in charge of scanning the entire rtl code, accumulating the
82 reload needs, spilling, assigning reload registers to use for
83 fixing up each insn, and generating the new insns to copy values
84 into the reload registers. */
86 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains a REG rtx for the hard reg
87 into which reg N has been reloaded (perhaps for a previous insn). */
88 static rtx *reg_last_reload_reg;
90 /* Elt N nonzero if reg_last_reload_reg[N] has been set in this insn
91 for an output reload that stores into reg N. */
92 static regset_head reg_has_output_reload;
94 /* Indicates which hard regs are reload-registers for an output reload
95 in the current insn. */
96 static HARD_REG_SET reg_is_output_reload;
98 /* Element N is the constant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
99 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a constant.
100 find_reloads looks at this in order to replace pseudo reg N
101 with the constant it stands for. */
102 rtx *reg_equiv_constant;
104 /* Element N is an invariant value to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
105 eliminate_regs_in_insn uses this to replace pseudos in particular
106 contexts. */
107 rtx *reg_equiv_invariant;
109 /* Element N is a memory location to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
110 prior to any register elimination (such as frame pointer to stack
111 pointer). Depending on whether or not it is a valid address, this value
112 is transferred to either reg_equiv_address or reg_equiv_mem. */
113 rtx *reg_equiv_memory_loc;
115 /* We allocate reg_equiv_memory_loc inside a varray so that the garbage
116 collector can keep track of what is inside. */
117 VEC(rtx,gc) *reg_equiv_memory_loc_vec;
119 /* Element N is the address of stack slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent.
120 This is used when the address is not valid as a memory address
121 (because its displacement is too big for the machine.) */
122 rtx *reg_equiv_address;
124 /* Element N is the memory slot to which pseudo reg N is equivalent,
125 or zero if pseudo reg N is not equivalent to a memory slot. */
126 rtx *reg_equiv_mem;
128 /* Element N is an EXPR_LIST of REG_EQUIVs containing MEMs with
129 alternate representations of the location of pseudo reg N. */
130 rtx *reg_equiv_alt_mem_list;
132 /* Widest width in which each pseudo reg is referred to (via subreg). */
133 static unsigned int *reg_max_ref_width;
135 /* Element N is the list of insns that initialized reg N from its equivalent
136 constant or memory slot. */
137 rtx *reg_equiv_init;
138 int reg_equiv_init_size;
140 /* Vector to remember old contents of reg_renumber before spilling. */
141 static short *reg_old_renumber;
143 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the last pseudo regno reloaded
144 into hard register N. If that pseudo reg occupied more than one register,
145 reg_reloaded_contents points to that pseudo for each spill register in
146 use; all of these must remain set for an inheritance to occur. */
147 static int reg_reloaded_contents[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
149 /* During reload_as_needed, element N contains the insn for which
150 hard register N was last used. Its contents are significant only
151 when reg_reloaded_valid is set for this register. */
152 static rtx reg_reloaded_insn[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
154 /* Indicate if reg_reloaded_insn / reg_reloaded_contents is valid. */
155 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_valid;
156 /* Indicate if the register was dead at the end of the reload.
157 This is only valid if reg_reloaded_contents is set and valid. */
158 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_dead;
160 /* Indicate whether the register's current value is one that is not
161 safe to retain across a call, even for registers that are normally
162 call-saved. This is only meaningful for members of reg_reloaded_valid. */
163 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered;
165 /* Number of spill-regs so far; number of valid elements of spill_regs. */
166 static int n_spills;
168 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains REG rtx's for those regs.
169 Holds the last rtx used for any given reg, or 0 if it has never
170 been used for spilling yet. This rtx is reused, provided it has
171 the proper mode. */
172 static rtx spill_reg_rtx[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
174 /* In parallel with spill_regs, contains nonzero for a spill reg
175 that was stored after the last time it was used.
176 The precise value is the insn generated to do the store. */
177 static rtx spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
179 /* This is the register that was stored with spill_reg_store. This is a
180 copy of reload_out / reload_out_reg when the value was stored; if
181 reload_out is a MEM, spill_reg_stored_to will be set to reload_out_reg. */
182 static rtx spill_reg_stored_to[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
184 /* This table is the inverse mapping of spill_regs:
185 indexed by hard reg number,
186 it contains the position of that reg in spill_regs,
187 or -1 for something that is not in spill_regs.
189 ?!? This is no longer accurate. */
190 static short spill_reg_order[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
192 /* This reg set indicates registers that can't be used as spill registers for
193 the currently processed insn. These are the hard registers which are live
194 during the insn, but not allocated to pseudos, as well as fixed
195 registers. */
196 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs;
198 /* These are the hard registers that can't be used as spill register for any
199 insn. This includes registers used for user variables and registers that
200 we can't eliminate. A register that appears in this set also can't be used
201 to retry register allocation. */
202 static HARD_REG_SET bad_spill_regs_global;
204 /* Describes order of use of registers for reloading
205 of spilled pseudo-registers. `n_spills' is the number of
206 elements that are actually valid; new ones are added at the end.
208 Both spill_regs and spill_reg_order are used on two occasions:
209 once during find_reload_regs, where they keep track of the spill registers
210 for a single insn, but also during reload_as_needed where they show all
211 the registers ever used by reload. For the latter case, the information
212 is calculated during finish_spills. */
213 static short spill_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
215 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard registers
216 may not be used for retrying global allocation because the register was
217 formerly spilled from one of them. If we allowed reallocating a pseudo to
218 a register that it was already allocated to, reload might not
219 terminate. */
220 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_previous_regs;
222 /* This vector of reg sets indicates, for each pseudo, which hard
223 registers may not be used for retrying global allocation because they
224 are used as spill registers during one of the insns in which the
225 pseudo is live. */
226 static HARD_REG_SET *pseudo_forbidden_regs;
228 /* All hard regs that have been used as spill registers for any insn are
229 marked in this set. */
230 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs;
232 /* Index of last register assigned as a spill register. We allocate in
233 a round-robin fashion. */
234 static int last_spill_reg;
236 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported on the machine; this means
237 that spilling (REG n) does not require reloading it into a register in
238 order to do (MEM (REG n)) or (MEM (PLUS (REG n) (CONST_INT c))). The
239 value indicates the level of indirect addressing supported, e.g., two
240 means that (MEM (MEM (REG n))) is also valid if (REG n) does not get
241 a hard register. */
242 static char spill_indirect_levels;
244 /* Nonzero if indirect addressing is supported when the innermost MEM is
245 of the form (MEM (SYMBOL_REF sym)). It is assumed that the level to
246 which these are valid is the same as spill_indirect_levels, above. */
247 char indirect_symref_ok;
249 /* Nonzero if an address (plus (reg frame_pointer) (reg ...)) is valid. */
250 char double_reg_address_ok;
252 /* Record the stack slot for each spilled hard register. */
253 static rtx spill_stack_slot[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
255 /* Width allocated so far for that stack slot. */
256 static unsigned int spill_stack_slot_width[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
258 /* Record which pseudos needed to be spilled. */
259 static regset_head spilled_pseudos;
261 /* Record which pseudos changed their allocation in finish_spills. */
262 static regset_head changed_allocation_pseudos;
264 /* Used for communication between order_regs_for_reload and count_pseudo.
265 Used to avoid counting one pseudo twice. */
266 static regset_head pseudos_counted;
268 /* First uid used by insns created by reload in this function.
269 Used in find_equiv_reg. */
270 int reload_first_uid;
272 /* Flag set by local-alloc or global-alloc if anything is live in
273 a call-clobbered reg across calls. */
274 int caller_save_needed;
276 /* Set to 1 while reload_as_needed is operating.
277 Required by some machines to handle any generated moves differently. */
278 int reload_in_progress = 0;
280 /* These arrays record the insn_code of insns that may be needed to
281 perform input and output reloads of special objects. They provide a
282 place to pass a scratch register. */
283 enum insn_code reload_in_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
284 enum insn_code reload_out_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
286 /* This obstack is used for allocation of rtl during register elimination.
287 The allocated storage can be freed once find_reloads has processed the
288 insn. */
289 static struct obstack reload_obstack;
291 /* Points to the beginning of the reload_obstack. All insn_chain structures
292 are allocated first. */
293 static char *reload_startobj;
295 /* The point after all insn_chain structures. Used to quickly deallocate
296 memory allocated in copy_reloads during calculate_needs_all_insns. */
297 static char *reload_firstobj;
299 /* This points before all local rtl generated by register elimination.
300 Used to quickly free all memory after processing one insn. */
301 static char *reload_insn_firstobj;
303 /* List of insn_chain instructions, one for every insn that reload needs to
304 examine. */
305 struct insn_chain *reload_insn_chain;
307 /* List of all insns needing reloads. */
308 static struct insn_chain *insns_need_reload;
310 /* This structure is used to record information about register eliminations.
311 Each array entry describes one possible way of eliminating a register
312 in favor of another. If there is more than one way of eliminating a
313 particular register, the most preferred should be specified first. */
315 struct elim_table
317 int from; /* Register number to be eliminated. */
318 int to; /* Register number used as replacement. */
319 HOST_WIDE_INT initial_offset; /* Initial difference between values. */
320 int can_eliminate; /* Nonzero if this elimination can be done. */
321 int can_eliminate_previous; /* Value of CAN_ELIMINATE in previous scan over
322 insns made by reload. */
323 HOST_WIDE_INT offset; /* Current offset between the two regs. */
324 HOST_WIDE_INT previous_offset;/* Offset at end of previous insn. */
325 int ref_outside_mem; /* "to" has been referenced outside a MEM. */
326 rtx from_rtx; /* REG rtx for the register to be eliminated.
327 We cannot simply compare the number since
328 we might then spuriously replace a hard
329 register corresponding to a pseudo
330 assigned to the reg to be eliminated. */
331 rtx to_rtx; /* REG rtx for the replacement. */
334 static struct elim_table *reg_eliminate = 0;
336 /* This is an intermediate structure to initialize the table. It has
337 exactly the members provided by ELIMINABLE_REGS. */
338 static const struct elim_table_1
340 const int from;
341 const int to;
342 } reg_eliminate_1[] =
344 /* If a set of eliminable registers was specified, define the table from it.
345 Otherwise, default to the normal case of the frame pointer being
346 replaced by the stack pointer. */
348 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
349 ELIMINABLE_REGS;
350 #else
351 {{ FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}};
352 #endif
354 #define NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS ARRAY_SIZE (reg_eliminate_1)
356 /* Record the number of pending eliminations that have an offset not equal
357 to their initial offset. If nonzero, we use a new copy of each
358 replacement result in any insns encountered. */
359 int num_not_at_initial_offset;
361 /* Count the number of registers that we may be able to eliminate. */
362 static int num_eliminable;
363 /* And the number of registers that are equivalent to a constant that
364 can be eliminated to frame_pointer / arg_pointer + constant. */
365 static int num_eliminable_invariants;
367 /* For each label, we record the offset of each elimination. If we reach
368 a label by more than one path and an offset differs, we cannot do the
369 elimination. This information is indexed by the difference of the
370 number of the label and the first label number. We can't offset the
371 pointer itself as this can cause problems on machines with segmented
372 memory. The first table is an array of flags that records whether we
373 have yet encountered a label and the second table is an array of arrays,
374 one entry in the latter array for each elimination. */
376 static int first_label_num;
377 static char *offsets_known_at;
378 static HOST_WIDE_INT (*offsets_at)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
380 /* Number of labels in the current function. */
382 static int num_labels;
384 static void replace_pseudos_in (rtx *, enum machine_mode, rtx);
385 static void maybe_fix_stack_asms (void);
386 static void copy_reloads (struct insn_chain *);
387 static void calculate_needs_all_insns (int);
388 static int find_reg (struct insn_chain *, int);
389 static void find_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *);
390 static void select_reload_regs (void);
391 static void delete_caller_save_insns (void);
393 static void spill_failure (rtx, enum reg_class);
394 static void count_spilled_pseudo (int, int, int);
395 static void delete_dead_insn (rtx);
396 static void alter_reg (int, int, bool);
397 static void set_label_offsets (rtx, rtx, int);
398 static void check_eliminable_occurrences (rtx);
399 static void elimination_effects (rtx, enum machine_mode);
400 static int eliminate_regs_in_insn (rtx, int);
401 static void update_eliminable_offsets (void);
402 static void mark_not_eliminable (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
403 static void set_initial_elim_offsets (void);
404 static bool verify_initial_elim_offsets (void);
405 static void set_initial_label_offsets (void);
406 static void set_offsets_for_label (rtx);
407 static void init_elim_table (void);
408 static void update_eliminables (HARD_REG_SET *);
409 static void spill_hard_reg (unsigned int, int);
410 static int finish_spills (int);
411 static void scan_paradoxical_subregs (rtx);
412 static void count_pseudo (int);
413 static void order_regs_for_reload (struct insn_chain *);
414 static void reload_as_needed (int);
415 static void forget_old_reloads_1 (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
416 static void forget_marked_reloads (regset);
417 static int reload_reg_class_lower (const void *, const void *);
418 static void mark_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type,
419 enum machine_mode);
420 static void clear_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type,
421 enum machine_mode);
422 static int reload_reg_free_p (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type);
423 static int reload_reg_free_for_value_p (int, int, int, enum reload_type,
424 rtx, rtx, int, int);
425 static int free_for_value_p (int, enum machine_mode, int, enum reload_type,
426 rtx, rtx, int, int);
427 static int reload_reg_reaches_end_p (unsigned int, int, enum reload_type);
428 static int allocate_reload_reg (struct insn_chain *, int, int);
429 static int conflicts_with_override (rtx);
430 static void failed_reload (rtx, int);
431 static int set_reload_reg (int, int);
432 static void choose_reload_regs_init (struct insn_chain *, rtx *);
433 static void choose_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *);
434 static void merge_assigned_reloads (rtx);
435 static void emit_input_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *,
436 rtx, int);
437 static void emit_output_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *,
438 int);
439 static void do_input_reload (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *, int);
440 static void do_output_reload (struct insn_chain *, struct reload *, int);
441 static void emit_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *);
442 static void delete_output_reload (rtx, int, int, rtx);
443 static void delete_address_reloads (rtx, rtx);
444 static void delete_address_reloads_1 (rtx, rtx, rtx);
445 static rtx inc_for_reload (rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
446 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
447 static void add_auto_inc_notes (rtx, rtx);
448 #endif
449 static void copy_eh_notes (rtx, rtx);
450 static void substitute (rtx *, const_rtx, rtx);
451 static bool gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p (int, int);
452 static int reloads_conflict (int, int);
453 static rtx gen_reload (rtx, rtx, int, enum reload_type);
454 static rtx emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (rtx);
456 /* Initialize the reload pass. This is called at the beginning of compilation
457 and may be called again if the target is reinitialized. */
459 void
460 init_reload (void)
462 int i;
464 /* Often (MEM (REG n)) is still valid even if (REG n) is put on the stack.
465 Set spill_indirect_levels to the number of levels such addressing is
466 permitted, zero if it is not permitted at all. */
468 rtx tem
469 = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
470 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
471 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode,
472 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1),
473 GEN_INT (4)));
474 spill_indirect_levels = 0;
476 while (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
478 spill_indirect_levels++;
479 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tem);
482 /* See if indirect addressing is valid for (MEM (SYMBOL_REF ...)). */
484 tem = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "foo"));
485 indirect_symref_ok = memory_address_p (QImode, tem);
487 /* See if reg+reg is a valid (and offsettable) address. */
489 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
491 tem = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
492 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM),
493 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, i));
495 /* This way, we make sure that reg+reg is an offsettable address. */
496 tem = plus_constant (tem, 4);
498 if (memory_address_p (QImode, tem))
500 double_reg_address_ok = 1;
501 break;
505 /* Initialize obstack for our rtl allocation. */
506 gcc_obstack_init (&reload_obstack);
507 reload_startobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
509 INIT_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
510 INIT_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos);
511 INIT_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
514 /* List of insn chains that are currently unused. */
515 static struct insn_chain *unused_insn_chains = 0;
517 /* Allocate an empty insn_chain structure. */
518 struct insn_chain *
519 new_insn_chain (void)
521 struct insn_chain *c;
523 if (unused_insn_chains == 0)
525 c = XOBNEW (&reload_obstack, struct insn_chain);
526 INIT_REG_SET (&c->live_throughout);
527 INIT_REG_SET (&c->dead_or_set);
529 else
531 c = unused_insn_chains;
532 unused_insn_chains = c->next;
534 c->is_caller_save_insn = 0;
535 c->need_operand_change = 0;
536 c->need_reload = 0;
537 c->need_elim = 0;
538 return c;
541 /* Small utility function to set all regs in hard reg set TO which are
542 allocated to pseudos in regset FROM. */
544 void
545 compute_use_by_pseudos (HARD_REG_SET *to, regset from)
547 unsigned int regno;
548 reg_set_iterator rsi;
550 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (from, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, regno, rsi)
552 int r = reg_renumber[regno];
554 if (r < 0)
556 /* reload_combine uses the information from DF_LIVE_IN,
557 which might still contain registers that have not
558 actually been allocated since they have an
559 equivalence. */
560 gcc_assert ((flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p) || reload_completed);
562 else
563 add_to_hard_reg_set (to, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno), r);
567 /* Replace all pseudos found in LOC with their corresponding
568 equivalences. */
570 static void
571 replace_pseudos_in (rtx *loc, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx usage)
573 rtx x = *loc;
574 enum rtx_code code;
575 const char *fmt;
576 int i, j;
578 if (! x)
579 return;
581 code = GET_CODE (x);
582 if (code == REG)
584 unsigned int regno = REGNO (x);
586 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
587 return;
589 x = eliminate_regs (x, mem_mode, usage);
590 if (x != *loc)
592 *loc = x;
593 replace_pseudos_in (loc, mem_mode, usage);
594 return;
597 if (reg_equiv_constant[regno])
598 *loc = reg_equiv_constant[regno];
599 else if (reg_equiv_mem[regno])
600 *loc = reg_equiv_mem[regno];
601 else if (reg_equiv_address[regno])
602 *loc = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x), reg_equiv_address[regno]);
603 else
605 gcc_assert (!REG_P (regno_reg_rtx[regno])
606 || REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[regno]) != regno);
607 *loc = regno_reg_rtx[regno];
610 return;
612 else if (code == MEM)
614 replace_pseudos_in (& XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x), usage);
615 return;
618 /* Process each of our operands recursively. */
619 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
620 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
621 if (*fmt == 'e')
622 replace_pseudos_in (&XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, usage);
623 else if (*fmt == 'E')
624 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
625 replace_pseudos_in (& XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, usage);
628 /* Determine if the current function has an exception receiver block
629 that reaches the exit block via non-exceptional edges */
631 static bool
632 has_nonexceptional_receiver (void)
634 edge e;
635 edge_iterator ei;
636 basic_block *tos, *worklist, bb;
638 /* If we're not optimizing, then just err on the safe side. */
639 if (!optimize)
640 return true;
642 /* First determine which blocks can reach exit via normal paths. */
643 tos = worklist = XNEWVEC (basic_block, n_basic_blocks + 1);
645 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
646 bb->flags &= ~BB_REACHABLE;
648 /* Place the exit block on our worklist. */
649 EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->flags |= BB_REACHABLE;
650 *tos++ = EXIT_BLOCK_PTR;
652 /* Iterate: find everything reachable from what we've already seen. */
653 while (tos != worklist)
655 bb = *--tos;
657 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
658 if (!(e->flags & EDGE_ABNORMAL))
660 basic_block src = e->src;
662 if (!(src->flags & BB_REACHABLE))
664 src->flags |= BB_REACHABLE;
665 *tos++ = src;
669 free (worklist);
671 /* Now see if there's a reachable block with an exceptional incoming
672 edge. */
673 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
674 if (bb->flags & BB_REACHABLE)
675 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
676 if (e->flags & EDGE_ABNORMAL)
677 return true;
679 /* No exceptional block reached exit unexceptionally. */
680 return false;
684 /* Global variables used by reload and its subroutines. */
686 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs register elimination. */
687 static int something_needs_elimination;
688 /* Set during calculate_needs if an insn needs an operand changed. */
689 static int something_needs_operands_changed;
691 /* Nonzero means we couldn't get enough spill regs. */
692 static int failure;
694 /* Temporary array of pseudo-register number. */
695 static int *temp_pseudo_reg_arr;
697 /* Main entry point for the reload pass.
699 FIRST is the first insn of the function being compiled.
701 GLOBAL nonzero means we were called from global_alloc
702 and should attempt to reallocate any pseudoregs that we
703 displace from hard regs we will use for reloads.
704 If GLOBAL is zero, we do not have enough information to do that,
705 so any pseudo reg that is spilled must go to the stack.
707 Return value is nonzero if reload failed
708 and we must not do any more for this function. */
711 reload (rtx first, int global)
713 int i, n;
714 rtx insn;
715 struct elim_table *ep;
716 basic_block bb;
718 /* Make sure even insns with volatile mem refs are recognizable. */
719 init_recog ();
721 failure = 0;
723 reload_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
725 /* Make sure that the last insn in the chain
726 is not something that needs reloading. */
727 emit_note (NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
729 /* Enable find_equiv_reg to distinguish insns made by reload. */
730 reload_first_uid = get_max_uid ();
732 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
733 /* Initialize the secondary memory table. */
734 clear_secondary_mem ();
735 #endif
737 /* We don't have a stack slot for any spill reg yet. */
738 memset (spill_stack_slot, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot);
739 memset (spill_stack_slot_width, 0, sizeof spill_stack_slot_width);
741 /* Initialize the save area information for caller-save, in case some
742 are needed. */
743 init_save_areas ();
745 /* Compute which hard registers are now in use
746 as homes for pseudo registers.
747 This is done here rather than (eg) in global_alloc
748 because this point is reached even if not optimizing. */
749 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
750 mark_home_live (i);
752 /* A function that has a nonlocal label that can reach the exit
753 block via non-exceptional paths must save all call-saved
754 registers. */
755 if (cfun->has_nonlocal_label
756 && has_nonexceptional_receiver ())
757 crtl->saves_all_registers = 1;
759 if (crtl->saves_all_registers)
760 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
761 if (! call_used_regs[i] && ! fixed_regs[i] && ! LOCAL_REGNO (i))
762 df_set_regs_ever_live (i, true);
764 /* Find all the pseudo registers that didn't get hard regs
765 but do have known equivalent constants or memory slots.
766 These include parameters (known equivalent to parameter slots)
767 and cse'd or loop-moved constant memory addresses.
769 Record constant equivalents in reg_equiv_constant
770 so they will be substituted by find_reloads.
771 Record memory equivalents in reg_mem_equiv so they can
772 be substituted eventually by altering the REG-rtx's. */
774 reg_equiv_constant = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
775 reg_equiv_invariant = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
776 reg_equiv_mem = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
777 reg_equiv_alt_mem_list = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
778 reg_equiv_address = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
779 reg_max_ref_width = XCNEWVEC (unsigned int, max_regno);
780 reg_old_renumber = XCNEWVEC (short, max_regno);
781 memcpy (reg_old_renumber, reg_renumber, max_regno * sizeof (short));
782 pseudo_forbidden_regs = XNEWVEC (HARD_REG_SET, max_regno);
783 pseudo_previous_regs = XCNEWVEC (HARD_REG_SET, max_regno);
785 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs_global);
787 /* Look for REG_EQUIV notes; record what each pseudo is equivalent
788 to. Also find all paradoxical subregs and find largest such for
789 each pseudo. */
791 num_eliminable_invariants = 0;
792 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
794 rtx set = single_set (insn);
796 /* We may introduce USEs that we want to remove at the end, so
797 we'll mark them with QImode. Make sure there are no
798 previously-marked insns left by say regmove. */
799 if (INSN_P (insn) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
800 && GET_MODE (insn) != VOIDmode)
801 PUT_MODE (insn, VOIDmode);
803 if (INSN_P (insn))
804 scan_paradoxical_subregs (PATTERN (insn));
806 if (set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (set)))
808 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, NULL_RTX);
809 rtx x;
811 if (! note)
812 continue;
814 i = REGNO (SET_DEST (set));
815 x = XEXP (note, 0);
817 if (i <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
818 continue;
820 if (! function_invariant_p (x)
821 || ! flag_pic
822 /* A function invariant is often CONSTANT_P but may
823 include a register. We promise to only pass
824 CONSTANT_P objects to LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P. */
825 || (CONSTANT_P (x)
826 && LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (x)))
828 /* It can happen that a REG_EQUIV note contains a MEM
829 that is not a legitimate memory operand. As later
830 stages of reload assume that all addresses found
831 in the reg_equiv_* arrays were originally legitimate,
832 we ignore such REG_EQUIV notes. */
833 if (memory_operand (x, VOIDmode))
835 /* Always unshare the equivalence, so we can
836 substitute into this insn without touching the
837 equivalence. */
838 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = copy_rtx (x);
840 else if (function_invariant_p (x))
842 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
844 /* This is PLUS of frame pointer and a constant,
845 and might be shared. Unshare it. */
846 reg_equiv_invariant[i] = copy_rtx (x);
847 num_eliminable_invariants++;
849 else if (x == frame_pointer_rtx || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
851 reg_equiv_invariant[i] = x;
852 num_eliminable_invariants++;
854 else if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
855 reg_equiv_constant[i] = x;
856 else
858 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]
859 = force_const_mem (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)), x);
860 if (! reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
861 reg_equiv_init[i] = NULL_RTX;
864 else
866 reg_equiv_init[i] = NULL_RTX;
867 continue;
870 else
871 reg_equiv_init[i] = NULL_RTX;
875 if (dump_file)
876 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
877 if (reg_equiv_init[i])
879 fprintf (dump_file, "init_insns for %u: ", i);
880 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, reg_equiv_init[i], 20);
881 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
884 init_elim_table ();
886 first_label_num = get_first_label_num ();
887 num_labels = max_label_num () - first_label_num;
889 /* Allocate the tables used to store offset information at labels. */
890 /* We used to use alloca here, but the size of what it would try to
891 allocate would occasionally cause it to exceed the stack limit and
892 cause a core dump. */
893 offsets_known_at = XNEWVEC (char, num_labels);
894 offsets_at = (HOST_WIDE_INT (*)[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]) xmalloc (num_labels * NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
896 /* Alter each pseudo-reg rtx to contain its hard reg number. Assign
897 stack slots to the pseudos that lack hard regs or equivalents.
898 Do not touch virtual registers. */
900 temp_pseudo_reg_arr = XNEWVEC (int, max_regno - LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER - 1);
901 for (n = 0, i = LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1; i < max_regno; i++)
902 temp_pseudo_reg_arr[n++] = i;
904 if (flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p)
905 /* Ask IRA to order pseudo-registers for better stack slot
906 sharing. */
907 ira_sort_regnos_for_alter_reg (temp_pseudo_reg_arr, n, reg_max_ref_width);
909 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
910 alter_reg (temp_pseudo_reg_arr[i], -1, false);
912 /* If we have some registers we think can be eliminated, scan all insns to
913 see if there is an insn that sets one of these registers to something
914 other than itself plus a constant. If so, the register cannot be
915 eliminated. Doing this scan here eliminates an extra pass through the
916 main reload loop in the most common case where register elimination
917 cannot be done. */
918 for (insn = first; insn && num_eliminable; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
919 if (INSN_P (insn))
920 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), mark_not_eliminable, NULL);
922 maybe_fix_stack_asms ();
924 insns_need_reload = 0;
925 something_needs_elimination = 0;
927 /* Initialize to -1, which means take the first spill register. */
928 last_spill_reg = -1;
930 /* Spill any hard regs that we know we can't eliminate. */
931 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
932 /* There can be multiple ways to eliminate a register;
933 they should be listed adjacently.
934 Elimination for any register fails only if all possible ways fail. */
935 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; )
937 int from = ep->from;
938 int can_eliminate = 0;
941 can_eliminate |= ep->can_eliminate;
942 ep++;
944 while (ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS] && ep->from == from);
945 if (! can_eliminate)
946 spill_hard_reg (from, 1);
949 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
950 if (frame_pointer_needed)
951 spill_hard_reg (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, 1);
952 #endif
953 finish_spills (global);
955 /* From now on, we may need to generate moves differently. We may also
956 allow modifications of insns which cause them to not be recognized.
957 Any such modifications will be cleaned up during reload itself. */
958 reload_in_progress = 1;
960 /* This loop scans the entire function each go-round
961 and repeats until one repetition spills no additional hard regs. */
962 for (;;)
964 int something_changed;
965 int did_spill;
966 HOST_WIDE_INT starting_frame_size;
968 starting_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
970 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
971 set_initial_label_offsets ();
973 /* For each pseudo register that has an equivalent location defined,
974 try to eliminate any eliminable registers (such as the frame pointer)
975 assuming initial offsets for the replacement register, which
976 is the normal case.
978 If the resulting location is directly addressable, substitute
979 the MEM we just got directly for the old REG.
981 If it is not addressable but is a constant or the sum of a hard reg
982 and constant, it is probably not addressable because the constant is
983 out of range, in that case record the address; we will generate
984 hairy code to compute the address in a register each time it is
985 needed. Similarly if it is a hard register, but one that is not
986 valid as an address register.
988 If the location is not addressable, but does not have one of the
989 above forms, assign a stack slot. We have to do this to avoid the
990 potential of producing lots of reloads if, e.g., a location involves
991 a pseudo that didn't get a hard register and has an equivalent memory
992 location that also involves a pseudo that didn't get a hard register.
994 Perhaps at some point we will improve reload_when_needed handling
995 so this problem goes away. But that's very hairy. */
997 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
998 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
1000 rtx x = eliminate_regs (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i], 0, NULL_RTX);
1002 if (strict_memory_address_p (GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]),
1003 XEXP (x, 0)))
1004 reg_equiv_mem[i] = x, reg_equiv_address[i] = 0;
1005 else if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))
1006 || (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
1007 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1008 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
1009 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
1010 && (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
1011 < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1012 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))))
1013 reg_equiv_address[i] = XEXP (x, 0), reg_equiv_mem[i] = 0;
1014 else
1016 /* Make a new stack slot. Then indicate that something
1017 changed so we go back and recompute offsets for
1018 eliminable registers because the allocation of memory
1019 below might change some offset. reg_equiv_{mem,address}
1020 will be set up for this pseudo on the next pass around
1021 the loop. */
1022 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = 0;
1023 reg_equiv_init[i] = 0;
1024 alter_reg (i, -1, true);
1028 if (caller_save_needed)
1029 setup_save_areas ();
1031 /* If we allocated another stack slot, redo elimination bookkeeping. */
1032 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
1033 continue;
1034 if (starting_frame_size && crtl->stack_alignment_needed)
1036 /* If we have a stack frame, we must align it now. The
1037 stack size may be a part of the offset computation for
1038 register elimination. So if this changes the stack size,
1039 then repeat the elimination bookkeeping. We don't
1040 realign when there is no stack, as that will cause a
1041 stack frame when none is needed should
1042 STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET not be already aligned to
1043 STACK_BOUNDARY. */
1044 assign_stack_local (BLKmode, 0, crtl->stack_alignment_needed);
1045 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
1046 continue;
1049 if (caller_save_needed)
1051 save_call_clobbered_regs ();
1052 /* That might have allocated new insn_chain structures. */
1053 reload_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
1056 calculate_needs_all_insns (global);
1058 if (! flag_ira || ! ira_conflicts_p)
1059 /* Don't do it for IRA. We need this info because we don't
1060 change live_throughout and dead_or_set for chains when IRA
1061 is used. */
1062 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
1064 did_spill = 0;
1066 something_changed = 0;
1068 /* If we allocated any new memory locations, make another pass
1069 since it might have changed elimination offsets. */
1070 if (starting_frame_size != get_frame_size ())
1071 something_changed = 1;
1073 /* Even if the frame size remained the same, we might still have
1074 changed elimination offsets, e.g. if find_reloads called
1075 force_const_mem requiring the back end to allocate a constant
1076 pool base register that needs to be saved on the stack. */
1077 else if (!verify_initial_elim_offsets ())
1078 something_changed = 1;
1081 HARD_REG_SET to_spill;
1082 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (to_spill);
1083 update_eliminables (&to_spill);
1084 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs, to_spill);
1086 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1087 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (to_spill, i))
1089 spill_hard_reg (i, 1);
1090 did_spill = 1;
1092 /* Regardless of the state of spills, if we previously had
1093 a register that we thought we could eliminate, but now can
1094 not eliminate, we must run another pass.
1096 Consider pseudos which have an entry in reg_equiv_* which
1097 reference an eliminable register. We must make another pass
1098 to update reg_equiv_* so that we do not substitute in the
1099 old value from when we thought the elimination could be
1100 performed. */
1101 something_changed = 1;
1105 select_reload_regs ();
1106 if (failure)
1107 goto failed;
1109 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || did_spill)
1110 something_changed |= finish_spills (global);
1112 if (! something_changed)
1113 break;
1115 if (caller_save_needed)
1116 delete_caller_save_insns ();
1118 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_firstobj);
1121 /* If global-alloc was run, notify it of any register eliminations we have
1122 done. */
1123 if (global)
1124 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
1125 if (ep->can_eliminate)
1126 mark_elimination (ep->from, ep->to);
1128 /* If a pseudo has no hard reg, delete the insns that made the equivalence.
1129 If that insn didn't set the register (i.e., it copied the register to
1130 memory), just delete that insn instead of the equivalencing insn plus
1131 anything now dead. If we call delete_dead_insn on that insn, we may
1132 delete the insn that actually sets the register if the register dies
1133 there and that is incorrect. */
1135 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1137 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0 && reg_equiv_init[i] != 0)
1139 rtx list;
1140 for (list = reg_equiv_init[i]; list; list = XEXP (list, 1))
1142 rtx equiv_insn = XEXP (list, 0);
1144 /* If we already deleted the insn or if it may trap, we can't
1145 delete it. The latter case shouldn't happen, but can
1146 if an insn has a variable address, gets a REG_EH_REGION
1147 note added to it, and then gets converted into a load
1148 from a constant address. */
1149 if (NOTE_P (equiv_insn)
1150 || can_throw_internal (equiv_insn))
1152 else if (reg_set_p (regno_reg_rtx[i], PATTERN (equiv_insn)))
1153 delete_dead_insn (equiv_insn);
1154 else
1155 SET_INSN_DELETED (equiv_insn);
1160 /* Use the reload registers where necessary
1161 by generating move instructions to move the must-be-register
1162 values into or out of the reload registers. */
1164 if (insns_need_reload != 0 || something_needs_elimination
1165 || something_needs_operands_changed)
1167 HOST_WIDE_INT old_frame_size = get_frame_size ();
1169 reload_as_needed (global);
1171 gcc_assert (old_frame_size == get_frame_size ());
1173 gcc_assert (verify_initial_elim_offsets ());
1176 /* If we were able to eliminate the frame pointer, show that it is no
1177 longer live at the start of any basic block. If it ls live by
1178 virtue of being in a pseudo, that pseudo will be marked live
1179 and hence the frame pointer will be known to be live via that
1180 pseudo. */
1182 if (! frame_pointer_needed)
1183 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
1184 bitmap_clear_bit (df_get_live_in (bb), HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1186 /* Come here (with failure set nonzero) if we can't get enough spill
1187 regs. */
1188 failed:
1190 CLEAR_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos);
1191 CLEAR_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos);
1192 reload_in_progress = 0;
1194 /* Now eliminate all pseudo regs by modifying them into
1195 their equivalent memory references.
1196 The REG-rtx's for the pseudos are modified in place,
1197 so all insns that used to refer to them now refer to memory.
1199 For a reg that has a reg_equiv_address, all those insns
1200 were changed by reloading so that no insns refer to it any longer;
1201 but the DECL_RTL of a variable decl may refer to it,
1202 and if so this causes the debugging info to mention the variable. */
1204 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
1206 rtx addr = 0;
1208 if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1209 addr = XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0);
1211 if (reg_equiv_address[i])
1212 addr = reg_equiv_address[i];
1214 if (addr)
1216 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
1218 rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[i];
1220 REG_USERVAR_P (reg) = 0;
1221 PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
1222 XEXP (reg, 0) = addr;
1223 if (reg_equiv_memory_loc[i])
1224 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (reg, reg_equiv_memory_loc[i]);
1225 else
1227 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (reg) = MEM_SCALAR_P (reg) = 0;
1228 MEM_ATTRS (reg) = 0;
1230 MEM_NOTRAP_P (reg) = 1;
1232 else if (reg_equiv_mem[i])
1233 XEXP (reg_equiv_mem[i], 0) = addr;
1237 /* We must set reload_completed now since the cleanup_subreg_operands call
1238 below will re-recognize each insn and reload may have generated insns
1239 which are only valid during and after reload. */
1240 reload_completed = 1;
1242 /* Make a pass over all the insns and delete all USEs which we inserted
1243 only to tag a REG_EQUAL note on them. Remove all REG_DEAD and REG_UNUSED
1244 notes. Delete all CLOBBER insns, except those that refer to the return
1245 value and the special mem:BLK CLOBBERs added to prevent the scheduler
1246 from misarranging variable-array code, and simplify (subreg (reg))
1247 operands. Strip and regenerate REG_INC notes that may have been moved
1248 around. */
1250 for (insn = first; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1251 if (INSN_P (insn))
1253 rtx *pnote;
1255 if (CALL_P (insn))
1256 replace_pseudos_in (& CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
1257 VOIDmode, CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
1259 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
1260 /* We mark with QImode USEs introduced by reload itself. */
1261 && (GET_MODE (insn) == QImode
1262 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX)))
1263 || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
1264 && (!MEM_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0))
1265 || GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) != BLKmode
1266 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)) != SCRATCH
1267 && XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
1268 != stack_pointer_rtx))
1269 && (!REG_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0))
1270 || ! REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))))
1272 delete_insn (insn);
1273 continue;
1276 /* Some CLOBBERs may survive until here and still reference unassigned
1277 pseudos with const equivalent, which may in turn cause ICE in later
1278 passes if the reference remains in place. */
1279 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
1280 replace_pseudos_in (& XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0),
1281 VOIDmode, PATTERN (insn));
1283 /* Discard obvious no-ops, even without -O. This optimization
1284 is fast and doesn't interfere with debugging. */
1285 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)
1286 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET
1287 && REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
1288 && REG_P (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)))
1289 && (REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn)))
1290 == REGNO (SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn)))))
1292 delete_insn (insn);
1293 continue;
1296 pnote = &REG_NOTES (insn);
1297 while (*pnote != 0)
1299 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_DEAD
1300 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_UNUSED
1301 || REG_NOTE_KIND (*pnote) == REG_INC)
1302 *pnote = XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1303 else
1304 pnote = &XEXP (*pnote, 1);
1307 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
1308 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, PATTERN (insn));
1309 #endif
1311 /* Simplify (subreg (reg)) if it appears as an operand. */
1312 cleanup_subreg_operands (insn);
1314 /* Clean up invalid ASMs so that they don't confuse later passes.
1315 See PR 21299. */
1316 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
1318 extract_insn (insn);
1319 if (!constrain_operands (1))
1321 error_for_asm (insn,
1322 "%<asm%> operand has impossible constraints");
1323 delete_insn (insn);
1324 continue;
1329 /* If we are doing generic stack checking, give a warning if this
1330 function's frame size is larger than we expect. */
1331 if (flag_stack_check == GENERIC_STACK_CHECK)
1333 HOST_WIDE_INT size = get_frame_size () + STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE;
1334 static int verbose_warned = 0;
1336 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1337 if (df_regs_ever_live_p (i) && ! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i])
1338 size += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1340 if (size > STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE)
1342 warning (0, "frame size too large for reliable stack checking");
1343 if (! verbose_warned)
1345 warning (0, "try reducing the number of local variables");
1346 verbose_warned = 1;
1351 /* Indicate that we no longer have known memory locations or constants. */
1352 if (reg_equiv_constant)
1353 free (reg_equiv_constant);
1354 if (reg_equiv_invariant)
1355 free (reg_equiv_invariant);
1356 reg_equiv_constant = 0;
1357 reg_equiv_invariant = 0;
1358 VEC_free (rtx, gc, reg_equiv_memory_loc_vec);
1359 reg_equiv_memory_loc = 0;
1361 free (temp_pseudo_reg_arr);
1363 if (offsets_known_at)
1364 free (offsets_known_at);
1365 if (offsets_at)
1366 free (offsets_at);
1368 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1369 if (reg_equiv_alt_mem_list[i])
1370 free_EXPR_LIST_list (&reg_equiv_alt_mem_list[i]);
1371 free (reg_equiv_alt_mem_list);
1373 free (reg_equiv_mem);
1374 reg_equiv_init = 0;
1375 free (reg_equiv_address);
1376 free (reg_max_ref_width);
1377 free (reg_old_renumber);
1378 free (pseudo_previous_regs);
1379 free (pseudo_forbidden_regs);
1381 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs);
1382 for (i = 0; i < n_spills; i++)
1383 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, spill_regs[i]);
1385 /* Free all the insn_chain structures at once. */
1386 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_startobj);
1387 unused_insn_chains = 0;
1388 fixup_abnormal_edges ();
1390 /* Replacing pseudos with their memory equivalents might have
1391 created shared rtx. Subsequent passes would get confused
1392 by this, so unshare everything here. */
1393 unshare_all_rtl_again (first);
1395 #ifdef STACK_BOUNDARY
1396 /* init_emit has set the alignment of the hard frame pointer
1397 to STACK_BOUNDARY. It is very likely no longer valid if
1398 the hard frame pointer was used for register allocation. */
1399 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
1400 REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) = BITS_PER_UNIT;
1401 #endif
1403 return failure;
1406 /* Yet another special case. Unfortunately, reg-stack forces people to
1407 write incorrect clobbers in asm statements. These clobbers must not
1408 cause the register to appear in bad_spill_regs, otherwise we'll call
1409 fatal_insn later. We clear the corresponding regnos in the live
1410 register sets to avoid this.
1411 The whole thing is rather sick, I'm afraid. */
1413 static void
1414 maybe_fix_stack_asms (void)
1416 #ifdef STACK_REGS
1417 const char *constraints[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1418 enum machine_mode operand_mode[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
1419 struct insn_chain *chain;
1421 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = chain->next)
1423 int i, noperands;
1424 HARD_REG_SET clobbered, allowed;
1425 rtx pat;
1427 if (! INSN_P (chain->insn)
1428 || (noperands = asm_noperands (PATTERN (chain->insn))) < 0)
1429 continue;
1430 pat = PATTERN (chain->insn);
1431 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
1432 continue;
1434 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (clobbered);
1435 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed);
1437 /* First, make a mask of all stack regs that are clobbered. */
1438 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (pat, 0); i++)
1440 rtx t = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
1441 if (GET_CODE (t) == CLOBBER && STACK_REG_P (XEXP (t, 0)))
1442 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (clobbered, REGNO (XEXP (t, 0)));
1445 /* Get the operand values and constraints out of the insn. */
1446 decode_asm_operands (pat, recog_data.operand, recog_data.operand_loc,
1447 constraints, operand_mode, NULL);
1449 /* For every operand, see what registers are allowed. */
1450 for (i = 0; i < noperands; i++)
1452 const char *p = constraints[i];
1453 /* For every alternative, we compute the class of registers allowed
1454 for reloading in CLS, and merge its contents into the reg set
1455 ALLOWED. */
1456 int cls = (int) NO_REGS;
1458 for (;;)
1460 char c = *p;
1462 if (c == '\0' || c == ',' || c == '#')
1464 /* End of one alternative - mark the regs in the current
1465 class, and reset the class. */
1466 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, reg_class_contents[cls]);
1467 cls = NO_REGS;
1468 p++;
1469 if (c == '#')
1470 do {
1471 c = *p++;
1472 } while (c != '\0' && c != ',');
1473 if (c == '\0')
1474 break;
1475 continue;
1478 switch (c)
1480 case '=': case '+': case '*': case '%': case '?': case '!':
1481 case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case '<':
1482 case '>': case 'V': case 'o': case '&': case 'E': case 'F':
1483 case 's': case 'i': case 'n': case 'X': case 'I': case 'J':
1484 case 'K': case 'L': case 'M': case 'N': case 'O': case 'P':
1485 case TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT:
1486 break;
1488 case 'p':
1489 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1490 [(int) base_reg_class (VOIDmode, ADDRESS, SCRATCH)];
1491 break;
1493 case 'g':
1494 case 'r':
1495 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls][(int) GENERAL_REGS];
1496 break;
1498 default:
1499 if (EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (c, p))
1500 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1501 [(int) base_reg_class (VOIDmode, ADDRESS, SCRATCH)];
1502 else
1503 cls = (int) reg_class_subunion[cls]
1504 [(int) REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (c, p)];
1506 p += CONSTRAINT_LEN (c, p);
1509 /* Those of the registers which are clobbered, but allowed by the
1510 constraints, must be usable as reload registers. So clear them
1511 out of the life information. */
1512 AND_HARD_REG_SET (allowed, clobbered);
1513 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1514 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (allowed, i))
1516 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, i);
1517 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, i);
1521 #endif
1524 /* Copy the global variables n_reloads and rld into the corresponding elts
1525 of CHAIN. */
1526 static void
1527 copy_reloads (struct insn_chain *chain)
1529 chain->n_reloads = n_reloads;
1530 chain->rld = XOBNEWVEC (&reload_obstack, struct reload, n_reloads);
1531 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1532 reload_insn_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
1535 /* Walk the chain of insns, and determine for each whether it needs reloads
1536 and/or eliminations. Build the corresponding insns_need_reload list, and
1537 set something_needs_elimination as appropriate. */
1538 static void
1539 calculate_needs_all_insns (int global)
1541 struct insn_chain **pprev_reload = &insns_need_reload;
1542 struct insn_chain *chain, *next = 0;
1544 something_needs_elimination = 0;
1546 reload_insn_firstobj = XOBNEWVAR (&reload_obstack, char, 0);
1547 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain != 0; chain = next)
1549 rtx insn = chain->insn;
1551 next = chain->next;
1553 /* Clear out the shortcuts. */
1554 chain->n_reloads = 0;
1555 chain->need_elim = 0;
1556 chain->need_reload = 0;
1557 chain->need_operand_change = 0;
1559 /* If this is a label, a JUMP_INSN, or has REG_NOTES (which might
1560 include REG_LABEL_OPERAND and REG_LABEL_TARGET), we need to see
1561 what effects this has on the known offsets at labels. */
1563 if (LABEL_P (insn) || JUMP_P (insn)
1564 || (INSN_P (insn) && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0))
1565 set_label_offsets (insn, insn, 0);
1567 if (INSN_P (insn))
1569 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
1570 int old_code = INSN_CODE (insn);
1571 rtx old_notes = REG_NOTES (insn);
1572 int did_elimination = 0;
1573 int operands_changed = 0;
1574 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1576 /* Skip insns that only set an equivalence. */
1577 if (set && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
1578 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1579 && (reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))]
1580 || (reg_equiv_invariant[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))]))
1581 && reg_equiv_init[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))])
1582 continue;
1584 /* If needed, eliminate any eliminable registers. */
1585 if (num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants)
1586 did_elimination = eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 0);
1588 /* Analyze the instruction. */
1589 operands_changed = find_reloads (insn, 0, spill_indirect_levels,
1590 global, spill_reg_order);
1592 /* If a no-op set needs more than one reload, this is likely
1593 to be something that needs input address reloads. We
1594 can't get rid of this cleanly later, and it is of no use
1595 anyway, so discard it now.
1596 We only do this when expensive_optimizations is enabled,
1597 since this complements reload inheritance / output
1598 reload deletion, and it can make debugging harder. */
1599 if (flag_expensive_optimizations && n_reloads > 1)
1601 rtx set = single_set (insn);
1602 if (set
1604 ((SET_SRC (set) == SET_DEST (set)
1605 && REG_P (SET_SRC (set))
1606 && REGNO (SET_SRC (set)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1607 || (REG_P (SET_SRC (set)) && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
1608 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))] < 0
1609 && reg_renumber[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] < 0
1610 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_SRC (set))] != NULL
1611 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SET_DEST (set))] != NULL
1612 && rtx_equal_p (reg_equiv_memory_loc
1613 [REGNO (SET_SRC (set))],
1614 reg_equiv_memory_loc
1615 [REGNO (SET_DEST (set))]))))
1617 if (flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p)
1618 /* Inform IRA about the insn deletion. */
1619 ira_mark_memory_move_deletion (REGNO (SET_DEST (set)),
1620 REGNO (SET_SRC (set)));
1621 delete_insn (insn);
1622 /* Delete it from the reload chain. */
1623 if (chain->prev)
1624 chain->prev->next = next;
1625 else
1626 reload_insn_chain = next;
1627 if (next)
1628 next->prev = chain->prev;
1629 chain->next = unused_insn_chains;
1630 unused_insn_chains = chain;
1631 continue;
1634 if (num_eliminable)
1635 update_eliminable_offsets ();
1637 /* Remember for later shortcuts which insns had any reloads or
1638 register eliminations. */
1639 chain->need_elim = did_elimination;
1640 chain->need_reload = n_reloads > 0;
1641 chain->need_operand_change = operands_changed;
1643 /* Discard any register replacements done. */
1644 if (did_elimination)
1646 obstack_free (&reload_obstack, reload_insn_firstobj);
1647 PATTERN (insn) = old_body;
1648 INSN_CODE (insn) = old_code;
1649 REG_NOTES (insn) = old_notes;
1650 something_needs_elimination = 1;
1653 something_needs_operands_changed |= operands_changed;
1655 if (n_reloads != 0)
1657 copy_reloads (chain);
1658 *pprev_reload = chain;
1659 pprev_reload = &chain->next_need_reload;
1663 *pprev_reload = 0;
1666 /* Comparison function for qsort to decide which of two reloads
1667 should be handled first. *P1 and *P2 are the reload numbers. */
1669 static int
1670 reload_reg_class_lower (const void *r1p, const void *r2p)
1672 int r1 = *(const short *) r1p, r2 = *(const short *) r2p;
1673 int t;
1675 /* Consider required reloads before optional ones. */
1676 t = rld[r1].optional - rld[r2].optional;
1677 if (t != 0)
1678 return t;
1680 /* Count all solitary classes before non-solitary ones. */
1681 t = ((reg_class_size[(int) rld[r2].rclass] == 1)
1682 - (reg_class_size[(int) rld[r1].rclass] == 1));
1683 if (t != 0)
1684 return t;
1686 /* Aside from solitaires, consider all multi-reg groups first. */
1687 t = rld[r2].nregs - rld[r1].nregs;
1688 if (t != 0)
1689 return t;
1691 /* Consider reloads in order of increasing reg-class number. */
1692 t = (int) rld[r1].rclass - (int) rld[r2].rclass;
1693 if (t != 0)
1694 return t;
1696 /* If reloads are equally urgent, sort by reload number,
1697 so that the results of qsort leave nothing to chance. */
1698 return r1 - r2;
1701 /* The cost of spilling each hard reg. */
1702 static int spill_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1704 /* When spilling multiple hard registers, we use SPILL_COST for the first
1705 spilled hard reg and SPILL_ADD_COST for subsequent regs. SPILL_ADD_COST
1706 only the first hard reg for a multi-reg pseudo. */
1707 static int spill_add_cost[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1709 /* Map of hard regno to pseudo regno currently occupying the hard
1710 reg. */
1711 static int hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1713 /* Update the spill cost arrays, considering that pseudo REG is live. */
1715 static void
1716 count_pseudo (int reg)
1718 int freq = REG_FREQ (reg);
1719 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1720 int nregs;
1722 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (&pseudos_counted, reg)
1723 || REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg)
1724 /* Ignore spilled pseudo-registers which can be here only if IRA
1725 is used. */
1726 || (flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p && r < 0))
1727 return;
1729 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted, reg);
1731 gcc_assert (r >= 0);
1733 spill_add_cost[r] += freq;
1734 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[r][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg)];
1735 while (nregs-- > 0)
1737 hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[r + nregs] = reg;
1738 spill_cost[r + nregs] += freq;
1742 /* Calculate the SPILL_COST and SPILL_ADD_COST arrays and determine the
1743 contents of BAD_SPILL_REGS for the insn described by CHAIN. */
1745 static void
1746 order_regs_for_reload (struct insn_chain *chain)
1748 unsigned i;
1749 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
1750 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
1751 reg_set_iterator rsi;
1753 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, fixed_reg_set);
1755 memset (spill_cost, 0, sizeof spill_cost);
1756 memset (spill_add_cost, 0, sizeof spill_add_cost);
1757 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1758 hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[i] = -1;
1760 /* Count number of uses of each hard reg by pseudo regs allocated to it
1761 and then order them by decreasing use. First exclude hard registers
1762 that are live in or across this insn. */
1764 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
1765 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
1766 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
1767 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (bad_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos2);
1769 /* Now find out which pseudos are allocated to it, and update
1770 hard_reg_n_uses. */
1771 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1773 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1774 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
1776 count_pseudo (i);
1778 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1779 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
1781 count_pseudo (i);
1783 CLEAR_REG_SET (&pseudos_counted);
1786 /* Vector of reload-numbers showing the order in which the reloads should
1787 be processed. */
1788 static short reload_order[MAX_RELOADS];
1790 /* This is used to keep track of the spill regs used in one insn. */
1791 static HARD_REG_SET used_spill_regs_local;
1793 /* We decided to spill hard register SPILLED, which has a size of
1794 SPILLED_NREGS. Determine how pseudo REG, which is live during the insn,
1795 is affected. We will add it to SPILLED_PSEUDOS if necessary, and we will
1796 update SPILL_COST/SPILL_ADD_COST. */
1798 static void
1799 count_spilled_pseudo (int spilled, int spilled_nregs, int reg)
1801 int freq = REG_FREQ (reg);
1802 int r = reg_renumber[reg];
1803 int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[r][PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (reg)];
1805 /* Ignore spilled pseudo-registers which can be here only if IRA is
1806 used. */
1807 if ((flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p && r < 0)
1808 || REGNO_REG_SET_P (&spilled_pseudos, reg)
1809 || spilled + spilled_nregs <= r || r + nregs <= spilled)
1810 return;
1812 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, reg);
1814 spill_add_cost[r] -= freq;
1815 while (nregs-- > 0)
1817 hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[r + nregs] = -1;
1818 spill_cost[r + nregs] -= freq;
1822 /* Find reload register to use for reload number ORDER. */
1824 static int
1825 find_reg (struct insn_chain *chain, int order)
1827 int rnum = reload_order[order];
1828 struct reload *rl = rld + rnum;
1829 int best_cost = INT_MAX;
1830 int best_reg = -1;
1831 unsigned int i, j, n;
1832 int k;
1833 HARD_REG_SET not_usable;
1834 HARD_REG_SET used_by_other_reload;
1835 reg_set_iterator rsi;
1836 static int regno_pseudo_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1837 static int best_regno_pseudo_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
1839 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs);
1840 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, bad_spill_regs_global);
1841 IOR_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (not_usable, reg_class_contents[rl->rclass]);
1843 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_other_reload);
1844 for (k = 0; k < order; k++)
1846 int other = reload_order[k];
1848 if (rld[other].regno >= 0 && reloads_conflict (other, rnum))
1849 for (j = 0; j < rld[other].nregs; j++)
1850 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, rld[other].regno + j);
1853 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1855 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1856 unsigned int regno = reg_alloc_order[i];
1857 #else
1858 unsigned int regno = i;
1859 #endif
1861 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno)
1862 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno)
1863 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rl->mode))
1865 int this_cost = spill_cost[regno];
1866 int ok = 1;
1867 unsigned int this_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][rl->mode];
1869 for (j = 1; j < this_nregs; j++)
1871 this_cost += spill_add_cost[regno + j];
1872 if ((TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (not_usable, regno + j))
1873 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_by_other_reload, regno + j))
1874 ok = 0;
1876 if (! ok)
1877 continue;
1879 if (flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p)
1881 /* Ask IRA to find a better pseudo-register for
1882 spilling. */
1883 for (n = j = 0; j < this_nregs; j++)
1885 int r = hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[regno + j];
1887 if (r < 0)
1888 continue;
1889 if (n == 0 || regno_pseudo_regs[n - 1] != r)
1890 regno_pseudo_regs[n++] = r;
1892 regno_pseudo_regs[n++] = -1;
1893 if (best_reg < 0
1894 || ira_better_spill_reload_regno_p (regno_pseudo_regs,
1895 best_regno_pseudo_regs,
1896 rl->in, rl->out,
1897 chain->insn))
1899 best_reg = regno;
1900 for (j = 0;; j++)
1902 best_regno_pseudo_regs[j] = regno_pseudo_regs[j];
1903 if (regno_pseudo_regs[j] < 0)
1904 break;
1907 continue;
1910 if (rl->in && REG_P (rl->in) && REGNO (rl->in) == regno)
1911 this_cost--;
1912 if (rl->out && REG_P (rl->out) && REGNO (rl->out) == regno)
1913 this_cost--;
1914 if (this_cost < best_cost
1915 /* Among registers with equal cost, prefer caller-saved ones, or
1916 use REG_ALLOC_ORDER if it is defined. */
1917 || (this_cost == best_cost
1918 #ifdef REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1919 && (inv_reg_alloc_order[regno]
1920 < inv_reg_alloc_order[best_reg])
1921 #else
1922 && call_used_regs[regno]
1923 && ! call_used_regs[best_reg]
1924 #endif
1927 best_reg = regno;
1928 best_cost = this_cost;
1932 if (best_reg == -1)
1933 return 0;
1935 if (dump_file)
1936 fprintf (dump_file, "Using reg %d for reload %d\n", best_reg, rnum);
1938 rl->nregs = hard_regno_nregs[best_reg][rl->mode];
1939 rl->regno = best_reg;
1941 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1942 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j, rsi)
1944 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1947 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
1948 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, j, rsi)
1950 count_spilled_pseudo (best_reg, rl->nregs, j);
1953 for (i = 0; i < rl->nregs; i++)
1955 gcc_assert (spill_cost[best_reg + i] == 0);
1956 gcc_assert (spill_add_cost[best_reg + i] == 0);
1957 gcc_assert (hard_regno_to_pseudo_regno[best_reg + i] == -1);
1958 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs_local, best_reg + i);
1960 return 1;
1963 /* Find more reload regs to satisfy the remaining need of an insn, which
1964 is given by CHAIN.
1965 Do it by ascending class number, since otherwise a reg
1966 might be spilled for a big class and might fail to count
1967 for a smaller class even though it belongs to that class. */
1969 static void
1970 find_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *chain)
1972 int i;
1974 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
1975 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
1976 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
1977 that provided the reload registers. */
1978 for (i = 0; i < chain->n_reloads; i++)
1980 /* Show whether this reload already has a hard reg. */
1981 if (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)
1983 int regno = REGNO (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx);
1984 chain->rld[i].regno = regno;
1985 chain->rld[i].nregs
1986 = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (chain->rld[i].reg_rtx)];
1988 else
1989 chain->rld[i].regno = -1;
1990 reload_order[i] = i;
1993 n_reloads = chain->n_reloads;
1994 memcpy (rld, chain->rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
1996 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs_local);
1998 if (dump_file)
1999 fprintf (dump_file, "Spilling for insn %d.\n", INSN_UID (chain->insn));
2001 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
2003 /* Compute the order of preference for hard registers to spill. */
2005 order_regs_for_reload (chain);
2007 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
2009 int r = reload_order[i];
2011 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
2012 if ((rld[r].out != 0 || rld[r].in != 0 || rld[r].secondary_p)
2013 && ! rld[r].optional
2014 && rld[r].regno == -1)
2015 if (! find_reg (chain, i))
2017 if (dump_file)
2018 fprintf (dump_file, "reload failure for reload %d\n", r);
2019 spill_failure (chain->insn, rld[r].rclass);
2020 failure = 1;
2021 return;
2025 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
2026 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs_local);
2028 memcpy (chain->rld, rld, n_reloads * sizeof (struct reload));
2031 static void
2032 select_reload_regs (void)
2034 struct insn_chain *chain;
2036 /* Try to satisfy the needs for each insn. */
2037 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain != 0;
2038 chain = chain->next_need_reload)
2039 find_reload_regs (chain);
2042 /* Delete all insns that were inserted by emit_caller_save_insns during
2043 this iteration. */
2044 static void
2045 delete_caller_save_insns (void)
2047 struct insn_chain *c = reload_insn_chain;
2049 while (c != 0)
2051 while (c != 0 && c->is_caller_save_insn)
2053 struct insn_chain *next = c->next;
2054 rtx insn = c->insn;
2056 if (c == reload_insn_chain)
2057 reload_insn_chain = next;
2058 delete_insn (insn);
2060 if (next)
2061 next->prev = c->prev;
2062 if (c->prev)
2063 c->prev->next = next;
2064 c->next = unused_insn_chains;
2065 unused_insn_chains = c;
2066 c = next;
2068 if (c != 0)
2069 c = c->next;
2073 /* Handle the failure to find a register to spill.
2074 INSN should be one of the insns which needed this particular spill reg. */
2076 static void
2077 spill_failure (rtx insn, enum reg_class rclass)
2079 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
2080 error_for_asm (insn, "can't find a register in class %qs while "
2081 "reloading %<asm%>",
2082 reg_class_names[rclass]);
2083 else
2085 error ("unable to find a register to spill in class %qs",
2086 reg_class_names[rclass]);
2088 if (dump_file)
2090 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
2091 debug_reload_to_stream (dump_file);
2093 fatal_insn ("this is the insn:", insn);
2097 /* Delete an unneeded INSN and any previous insns who sole purpose is loading
2098 data that is dead in INSN. */
2100 static void
2101 delete_dead_insn (rtx insn)
2103 rtx prev = prev_real_insn (insn);
2104 rtx prev_dest;
2106 /* If the previous insn sets a register that dies in our insn, delete it
2107 too. */
2108 if (prev && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SET
2109 && (prev_dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (prev)), REG_P (prev_dest))
2110 && reg_mentioned_p (prev_dest, PATTERN (insn))
2111 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (prev_dest))
2112 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (prev))))
2113 delete_dead_insn (prev);
2115 SET_INSN_DELETED (insn);
2118 /* Modify the home of pseudo-reg I.
2119 The new home is present in reg_renumber[I].
2121 FROM_REG may be the hard reg that the pseudo-reg is being spilled from;
2122 or it may be -1, meaning there is none or it is not relevant.
2123 This is used so that all pseudos spilled from a given hard reg
2124 can share one stack slot. */
2126 static void
2127 alter_reg (int i, int from_reg, bool dont_share_p)
2129 /* When outputting an inline function, this can happen
2130 for a reg that isn't actually used. */
2131 if (regno_reg_rtx[i] == 0)
2132 return;
2134 /* If the reg got changed to a MEM at rtl-generation time,
2135 ignore it. */
2136 if (!REG_P (regno_reg_rtx[i]))
2137 return;
2139 /* Modify the reg-rtx to contain the new hard reg
2140 number or else to contain its pseudo reg number. */
2141 SET_REGNO (regno_reg_rtx[i],
2142 reg_renumber[i] >= 0 ? reg_renumber[i] : i);
2144 /* If we have a pseudo that is needed but has no hard reg or equivalent,
2145 allocate a stack slot for it. */
2147 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0
2148 && REG_N_REFS (i) > 0
2149 && reg_equiv_constant[i] == 0
2150 && (reg_equiv_invariant[i] == 0 || reg_equiv_init[i] == 0)
2151 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] == 0)
2153 rtx x = NULL_RTX;
2154 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]);
2155 unsigned int inherent_size = PSEUDO_REGNO_BYTES (i);
2156 unsigned int inherent_align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
2157 unsigned int total_size = MAX (inherent_size, reg_max_ref_width[i]);
2158 unsigned int min_align = reg_max_ref_width[i] * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2159 int adjust = 0;
2161 if (flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p)
2163 /* Mark the spill for IRA. */
2164 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
2165 if (!dont_share_p)
2166 x = ira_reuse_stack_slot (i, inherent_size, total_size);
2169 if (x)
2172 /* Each pseudo reg has an inherent size which comes from its own mode,
2173 and a total size which provides room for paradoxical subregs
2174 which refer to the pseudo reg in wider modes.
2176 We can use a slot already allocated if it provides both
2177 enough inherent space and enough total space.
2178 Otherwise, we allocate a new slot, making sure that it has no less
2179 inherent space, and no less total space, then the previous slot. */
2180 else if (from_reg == -1
2181 || (!dont_share_p && flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p))
2183 rtx stack_slot;
2185 /* No known place to spill from => no slot to reuse. */
2186 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
2187 min_align > inherent_align
2188 || total_size > inherent_size ? -1 : 0);
2190 stack_slot = x;
2192 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2193 Get the address of the beginning of the slot. This is so we
2194 can do a big-endian correction unconditionally below. */
2195 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2197 adjust = inherent_size - total_size;
2198 if (adjust)
2199 stack_slot
2200 = adjust_address_nv (x, mode_for_size (total_size
2201 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2202 MODE_INT, 1),
2203 adjust);
2206 if (! dont_share_p && flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p)
2207 /* Inform IRA about allocation a new stack slot. */
2208 ira_mark_new_stack_slot (stack_slot, i, total_size);
2211 /* Reuse a stack slot if possible. */
2212 else if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg] != 0
2213 && spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] >= total_size
2214 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
2215 >= inherent_size)
2216 && MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]) >= min_align)
2217 x = spill_stack_slot[from_reg];
2219 /* Allocate a bigger slot. */
2220 else
2222 /* Compute maximum size needed, both for inherent size
2223 and for total size. */
2224 rtx stack_slot;
2226 if (spill_stack_slot[from_reg])
2228 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]))
2229 > inherent_size)
2230 mode = GET_MODE (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2231 if (spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] > total_size)
2232 total_size = spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg];
2233 if (MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]) > min_align)
2234 min_align = MEM_ALIGN (spill_stack_slot[from_reg]);
2237 /* Make a slot with that size. */
2238 x = assign_stack_local (mode, total_size,
2239 min_align > inherent_align
2240 || total_size > inherent_size ? -1 : 0);
2241 stack_slot = x;
2243 /* Cancel the big-endian correction done in assign_stack_local.
2244 Get the address of the beginning of the slot. This is so we
2245 can do a big-endian correction unconditionally below. */
2246 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2248 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - total_size;
2249 if (adjust)
2250 stack_slot
2251 = adjust_address_nv (x, mode_for_size (total_size
2252 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2253 MODE_INT, 1),
2254 adjust);
2257 spill_stack_slot[from_reg] = stack_slot;
2258 spill_stack_slot_width[from_reg] = total_size;
2261 /* On a big endian machine, the "address" of the slot
2262 is the address of the low part that fits its inherent mode. */
2263 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && inherent_size < total_size)
2264 adjust += (total_size - inherent_size);
2266 /* If we have any adjustment to make, or if the stack slot is the
2267 wrong mode, make a new stack slot. */
2268 x = adjust_address_nv (x, GET_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[i]), adjust);
2270 /* Set all of the memory attributes as appropriate for a spill. */
2271 set_mem_attrs_for_spill (x);
2273 /* Save the stack slot for later. */
2274 reg_equiv_memory_loc[i] = x;
2278 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs used by
2279 pseudo-reg number REGNO, accessed in MODE. */
2281 static void
2282 mark_home_live_1 (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
2284 int i, lim;
2286 i = reg_renumber[regno];
2287 if (i < 0)
2288 return;
2289 lim = end_hard_regno (mode, i);
2290 while (i < lim)
2291 df_set_regs_ever_live(i++, true);
2294 /* Mark the slots in regs_ever_live for the hard regs
2295 used by pseudo-reg number REGNO. */
2297 void
2298 mark_home_live (int regno)
2300 if (reg_renumber[regno] >= 0)
2301 mark_home_live_1 (regno, PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (regno));
2304 /* This function handles the tracking of elimination offsets around branches.
2306 X is a piece of RTL being scanned.
2308 INSN is the insn that it came from, if any.
2310 INITIAL_P is nonzero if we are to set the offset to be the initial
2311 offset and zero if we are setting the offset of the label to be the
2312 current offset. */
2314 static void
2315 set_label_offsets (rtx x, rtx insn, int initial_p)
2317 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2318 rtx tem;
2319 unsigned int i;
2320 struct elim_table *p;
2322 switch (code)
2324 case LABEL_REF:
2325 if (LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (x))
2326 return;
2328 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2330 /* ... fall through ... */
2332 case CODE_LABEL:
2333 /* If we know nothing about this label, set the desired offsets. Note
2334 that this sets the offset at a label to be the offset before a label
2335 if we don't know anything about the label. This is not correct for
2336 the label after a BARRIER, but is the best guess we can make. If
2337 we guessed wrong, we will suppress an elimination that might have
2338 been possible had we been able to guess correctly. */
2340 if (! offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num])
2342 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2343 offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num][i]
2344 = (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2345 : reg_eliminate[i].offset);
2346 offsets_known_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num] = 1;
2349 /* Otherwise, if this is the definition of a label and it is
2350 preceded by a BARRIER, set our offsets to the known offset of
2351 that label. */
2353 else if (x == insn
2354 && (tem = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
2355 && BARRIER_P (tem))
2356 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
2357 else
2358 /* If neither of the above cases is true, compare each offset
2359 with those previously recorded and suppress any eliminations
2360 where the offsets disagree. */
2362 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
2363 if (offsets_at[CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (x) - first_label_num][i]
2364 != (initial_p ? reg_eliminate[i].initial_offset
2365 : reg_eliminate[i].offset))
2366 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
2368 return;
2370 case JUMP_INSN:
2371 set_label_offsets (PATTERN (insn), insn, initial_p);
2373 /* ... fall through ... */
2375 case INSN:
2376 case CALL_INSN:
2377 /* Any labels mentioned in REG_LABEL_OPERAND notes can be branched
2378 to indirectly and hence must have all eliminations at their
2379 initial offsets. */
2380 for (tem = REG_NOTES (x); tem; tem = XEXP (tem, 1))
2381 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (tem) == REG_LABEL_OPERAND)
2382 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, 1);
2383 return;
2385 case PARALLEL:
2386 case ADDR_VEC:
2387 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2388 /* Each of the labels in the parallel or address vector must be
2389 at their initial offsets. We want the first field for PARALLEL
2390 and ADDR_VEC and the second field for ADDR_DIFF_VEC. */
2392 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned) XVECLEN (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC); i++)
2393 set_label_offsets (XVECEXP (x, code == ADDR_DIFF_VEC, i),
2394 insn, initial_p);
2395 return;
2397 case SET:
2398 /* We only care about setting PC. If the source is not RETURN,
2399 IF_THEN_ELSE, or a label, disable any eliminations not at
2400 their initial offsets. Similarly if any arm of the IF_THEN_ELSE
2401 isn't one of those possibilities. For branches to a label,
2402 call ourselves recursively.
2404 Note that this can disable elimination unnecessarily when we have
2405 a non-local goto since it will look like a non-constant jump to
2406 someplace in the current function. This isn't a significant
2407 problem since such jumps will normally be when all elimination
2408 pairs are back to their initial offsets. */
2410 if (SET_DEST (x) != pc_rtx)
2411 return;
2413 switch (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)))
2415 case PC:
2416 case RETURN:
2417 return;
2419 case LABEL_REF:
2420 set_label_offsets (SET_SRC (x), insn, initial_p);
2421 return;
2423 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
2424 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1);
2425 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2426 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2427 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2428 break;
2430 tem = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 2);
2431 if (GET_CODE (tem) == LABEL_REF)
2432 set_label_offsets (XEXP (tem, 0), insn, initial_p);
2433 else if (GET_CODE (tem) != PC && GET_CODE (tem) != RETURN)
2434 break;
2435 return;
2437 default:
2438 break;
2441 /* If we reach here, all eliminations must be at their initial
2442 offset because we are doing a jump to a variable address. */
2443 for (p = reg_eliminate; p < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; p++)
2444 if (p->offset != p->initial_offset)
2445 p->can_eliminate = 0;
2446 break;
2448 default:
2449 break;
2453 /* Scan X and replace any eliminable registers (such as fp) with a
2454 replacement (such as sp), plus an offset.
2456 MEM_MODE is the mode of an enclosing MEM. We need this to know how
2457 much to adjust a register for, e.g., PRE_DEC. Also, if we are inside a
2458 MEM, we are allowed to replace a sum of a register and the constant zero
2459 with the register, which we cannot do outside a MEM. In addition, we need
2460 to record the fact that a register is referenced outside a MEM.
2462 If INSN is an insn, it is the insn containing X. If we replace a REG
2463 in a SET_DEST with an equivalent MEM and INSN is nonzero, write a
2464 CLOBBER of the pseudo after INSN so find_equiv_regs will know that
2465 the REG is being modified.
2467 Alternatively, INSN may be a note (an EXPR_LIST or INSN_LIST).
2468 That's used when we eliminate in expressions stored in notes.
2469 This means, do not set ref_outside_mem even if the reference
2470 is outside of MEMs.
2472 REG_EQUIV_MEM and REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS contain address that have had
2473 replacements done assuming all offsets are at their initial values. If
2474 they are not, or if REG_EQUIV_ADDRESS is nonzero for a pseudo we
2475 encounter, return the actual location so that find_reloads will do
2476 the proper thing. */
2478 static rtx
2479 eliminate_regs_1 (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx insn,
2480 bool may_use_invariant)
2482 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2483 struct elim_table *ep;
2484 int regno;
2485 rtx new_rtx;
2486 int i, j;
2487 const char *fmt;
2488 int copied = 0;
2490 if (! current_function_decl)
2491 return x;
2493 switch (code)
2495 case CONST_INT:
2496 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2497 case CONST_FIXED:
2498 case CONST_VECTOR:
2499 case CONST:
2500 case SYMBOL_REF:
2501 case CODE_LABEL:
2502 case PC:
2503 case CC0:
2504 case ASM_INPUT:
2505 case ADDR_VEC:
2506 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2507 case RETURN:
2508 return x;
2510 case REG:
2511 regno = REGNO (x);
2513 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2514 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2515 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2517 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2518 ep++)
2519 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2520 return plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, ep->previous_offset);
2523 else if (reg_renumber && reg_renumber[regno] < 0
2524 && reg_equiv_invariant && reg_equiv_invariant[regno])
2526 if (may_use_invariant)
2527 return eliminate_regs_1 (copy_rtx (reg_equiv_invariant[regno]),
2528 mem_mode, insn, true);
2529 /* There exists at least one use of REGNO that cannot be
2530 eliminated. Prevent the defining insn from being deleted. */
2531 reg_equiv_init[regno] = NULL_RTX;
2532 alter_reg (regno, -1, true);
2534 return x;
2536 /* You might think handling MINUS in a manner similar to PLUS is a
2537 good idea. It is not. It has been tried multiple times and every
2538 time the change has had to have been reverted.
2540 Other parts of reload know a PLUS is special (gen_reload for example)
2541 and require special code to handle code a reloaded PLUS operand.
2543 Also consider backends where the flags register is clobbered by a
2544 MINUS, but we can emit a PLUS that does not clobber flags (IA-32,
2545 lea instruction comes to mind). If we try to reload a MINUS, we
2546 may kill the flags register that was holding a useful value.
2548 So, please before trying to handle MINUS, consider reload as a
2549 whole instead of this little section as well as the backend issues. */
2550 case PLUS:
2551 /* If this is the sum of an eliminable register and a constant, rework
2552 the sum. */
2553 if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
2554 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2555 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
2557 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2558 ep++)
2559 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2561 /* The only time we want to replace a PLUS with a REG (this
2562 occurs when the constant operand of the PLUS is the negative
2563 of the offset) is when we are inside a MEM. We won't want
2564 to do so at other times because that would change the
2565 structure of the insn in a way that reload can't handle.
2566 We special-case the commonest situation in
2567 eliminate_regs_in_insn, so just replace a PLUS with a
2568 PLUS here, unless inside a MEM. */
2569 if (mem_mode != 0 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
2570 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == - ep->previous_offset)
2571 return ep->to_rtx;
2572 else
2573 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, ep->to_rtx,
2574 plus_constant (XEXP (x, 1),
2575 ep->previous_offset));
2578 /* If the register is not eliminable, we are done since the other
2579 operand is a constant. */
2580 return x;
2583 /* If this is part of an address, we want to bring any constant to the
2584 outermost PLUS. We will do this by doing register replacement in
2585 our operands and seeing if a constant shows up in one of them.
2587 Note that there is no risk of modifying the structure of the insn,
2588 since we only get called for its operands, thus we are either
2589 modifying the address inside a MEM, or something like an address
2590 operand of a load-address insn. */
2593 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, true);
2594 rtx new1 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true);
2596 if (reg_renumber && (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1)))
2598 /* If one side is a PLUS and the other side is a pseudo that
2599 didn't get a hard register but has a reg_equiv_constant,
2600 we must replace the constant here since it may no longer
2601 be in the position of any operand. */
2602 if (GET_CODE (new0) == PLUS && REG_P (new1)
2603 && REGNO (new1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2604 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new1)] < 0
2605 && reg_equiv_constant != 0
2606 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)] != 0)
2607 new1 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new1)];
2608 else if (GET_CODE (new1) == PLUS && REG_P (new0)
2609 && REGNO (new0) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2610 && reg_renumber[REGNO (new0)] < 0
2611 && reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)] != 0)
2612 new0 = reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (new0)];
2614 new_rtx = form_sum (new0, new1);
2616 /* As above, if we are not inside a MEM we do not want to
2617 turn a PLUS into something else. We might try to do so here
2618 for an addition of 0 if we aren't optimizing. */
2619 if (! mem_mode && GET_CODE (new_rtx) != PLUS)
2620 return gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx, const0_rtx);
2621 else
2622 return new_rtx;
2625 return x;
2627 case MULT:
2628 /* If this is the product of an eliminable register and a
2629 constant, apply the distribute law and move the constant out
2630 so that we have (plus (mult ..) ..). This is needed in order
2631 to keep load-address insns valid. This case is pathological.
2632 We ignore the possibility of overflow here. */
2633 if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
2634 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2635 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2636 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2637 ep++)
2638 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0) && ep->can_eliminate)
2640 if (! mem_mode
2641 /* Refs inside notes don't count for this purpose. */
2642 && ! (insn != 0 && (GET_CODE (insn) == EXPR_LIST
2643 || GET_CODE (insn) == INSN_LIST)))
2644 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2646 return
2647 plus_constant (gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, ep->to_rtx, XEXP (x, 1)),
2648 ep->previous_offset * INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
2651 /* ... fall through ... */
2653 case CALL:
2654 case COMPARE:
2655 /* See comments before PLUS about handling MINUS. */
2656 case MINUS:
2657 case DIV: case UDIV:
2658 case MOD: case UMOD:
2659 case AND: case IOR: case XOR:
2660 case ROTATERT: case ROTATE:
2661 case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFT:
2662 case NE: case EQ:
2663 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2664 case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2666 rtx new0 = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, false);
2667 rtx new1 = XEXP (x, 1)
2668 ? eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, false) : 0;
2670 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
2671 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), new0, new1);
2673 return x;
2675 case EXPR_LIST:
2676 /* If we have something in XEXP (x, 0), the usual case, eliminate it. */
2677 if (XEXP (x, 0))
2679 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, true);
2680 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 0))
2682 /* If this is a REG_DEAD note, it is not valid anymore.
2683 Using the eliminated version could result in creating a
2684 REG_DEAD note for the stack or frame pointer. */
2685 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_DEAD)
2686 return (XEXP (x, 1)
2687 ? eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true)
2688 : NULL_RTX);
2690 x = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (x), new_rtx, XEXP (x, 1));
2694 /* ... fall through ... */
2696 case INSN_LIST:
2697 /* Now do eliminations in the rest of the chain. If this was
2698 an EXPR_LIST, this might result in allocating more memory than is
2699 strictly needed, but it simplifies the code. */
2700 if (XEXP (x, 1))
2702 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 1), mem_mode, insn, true);
2703 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 1))
2704 return
2705 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0), new_rtx);
2707 return x;
2709 case PRE_INC:
2710 case POST_INC:
2711 case PRE_DEC:
2712 case POST_DEC:
2713 /* We do not support elimination of a register that is modified.
2714 elimination_effects has already make sure that this does not
2715 happen. */
2716 return x;
2718 case PRE_MODIFY:
2719 case POST_MODIFY:
2720 /* We do not support elimination of a register that is modified.
2721 elimination_effects has already make sure that this does not
2722 happen. The only remaining case we need to consider here is
2723 that the increment value may be an eliminable register. */
2724 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
2725 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0) == XEXP (x, 0))
2727 rtx new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1), mem_mode,
2728 insn, true);
2730 if (new_rtx != XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1))
2731 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
2732 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x),
2733 XEXP (x, 0), new_rtx));
2735 return x;
2737 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2738 case NEG: case NOT:
2739 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2740 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2741 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2742 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2743 case ABS:
2744 case SQRT:
2745 case FFS:
2746 case CLZ:
2747 case CTZ:
2748 case POPCOUNT:
2749 case PARITY:
2750 case BSWAP:
2751 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode, insn, false);
2752 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 0))
2753 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (x), new_rtx);
2754 return x;
2756 case SUBREG:
2757 /* Similar to above processing, but preserve SUBREG_BYTE.
2758 Convert (subreg (mem)) to (mem) if not paradoxical.
2759 Also, if we have a non-paradoxical (subreg (pseudo)) and the
2760 pseudo didn't get a hard reg, we must replace this with the
2761 eliminated version of the memory location because push_reload
2762 may do the replacement in certain circumstances. */
2763 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
2764 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2765 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
2766 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
2767 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
2769 new_rtx = SUBREG_REG (x);
2771 else
2772 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode, insn, false);
2774 if (new_rtx != SUBREG_REG (x))
2776 int x_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
2777 int new_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (new_rtx));
2779 if (MEM_P (new_rtx)
2780 && ((x_size < new_size
2781 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
2782 /* On these machines, combine can create rtl of the form
2783 (set (subreg:m1 (reg:m2 R) 0) ...)
2784 where m1 < m2, and expects something interesting to
2785 happen to the entire word. Moreover, it will use the
2786 (reg:m2 R) later, expecting all bits to be preserved.
2787 So if the number of words is the same, preserve the
2788 subreg so that push_reload can see it. */
2789 && ! ((x_size - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD
2790 == (new_size -1 ) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2791 #endif
2793 || x_size == new_size)
2795 return adjust_address_nv (new_rtx, GET_MODE (x), SUBREG_BYTE (x));
2796 else
2797 return gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx, SUBREG_BYTE (x));
2800 return x;
2802 case MEM:
2803 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
2804 recursive call and copy the flags. While we are here, handle this
2805 case more efficiently. */
2806 return
2807 replace_equiv_address_nv (x,
2808 eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x),
2809 insn, true));
2811 case USE:
2812 /* Handle insn_list USE that a call to a pure function may generate. */
2813 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, 0), 0, insn, false);
2814 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, 0))
2815 return gen_rtx_USE (GET_MODE (x), new_rtx);
2816 return x;
2818 case CLOBBER:
2819 case ASM_OPERANDS:
2820 case SET:
2821 gcc_unreachable ();
2823 default:
2824 break;
2827 /* Process each of our operands recursively. If any have changed, make a
2828 copy of the rtx. */
2829 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
2830 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
2832 if (*fmt == 'e')
2834 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode, insn, false);
2835 if (new_rtx != XEXP (x, i) && ! copied)
2837 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
2838 copied = 1;
2840 XEXP (x, i) = new_rtx;
2842 else if (*fmt == 'E')
2844 int copied_vec = 0;
2845 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
2847 new_rtx = eliminate_regs_1 (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode, insn, false);
2848 if (new_rtx != XVECEXP (x, i, j) && ! copied_vec)
2850 rtvec new_v = gen_rtvec_v (XVECLEN (x, i),
2851 XVEC (x, i)->elem);
2852 if (! copied)
2854 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
2855 copied = 1;
2857 XVEC (x, i) = new_v;
2858 copied_vec = 1;
2860 XVECEXP (x, i, j) = new_rtx;
2865 return x;
2869 eliminate_regs (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode, rtx insn)
2871 return eliminate_regs_1 (x, mem_mode, insn, false);
2874 /* Scan rtx X for modifications of elimination target registers. Update
2875 the table of eliminables to reflect the changed state. MEM_MODE is
2876 the mode of an enclosing MEM rtx, or VOIDmode if not within a MEM. */
2878 static void
2879 elimination_effects (rtx x, enum machine_mode mem_mode)
2881 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
2882 struct elim_table *ep;
2883 int regno;
2884 int i, j;
2885 const char *fmt;
2887 switch (code)
2889 case CONST_INT:
2890 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2891 case CONST_FIXED:
2892 case CONST_VECTOR:
2893 case CONST:
2894 case SYMBOL_REF:
2895 case CODE_LABEL:
2896 case PC:
2897 case CC0:
2898 case ASM_INPUT:
2899 case ADDR_VEC:
2900 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
2901 case RETURN:
2902 return;
2904 case REG:
2905 regno = REGNO (x);
2907 /* First handle the case where we encounter a bare register that
2908 is eliminable. Replace it with a PLUS. */
2909 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2911 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
2912 ep++)
2913 if (ep->from_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
2915 if (! mem_mode)
2916 ep->ref_outside_mem = 1;
2917 return;
2921 else if (reg_renumber[regno] < 0 && reg_equiv_constant
2922 && reg_equiv_constant[regno]
2923 && ! function_invariant_p (reg_equiv_constant[regno]))
2924 elimination_effects (reg_equiv_constant[regno], mem_mode);
2925 return;
2927 case PRE_INC:
2928 case POST_INC:
2929 case PRE_DEC:
2930 case POST_DEC:
2931 case POST_MODIFY:
2932 case PRE_MODIFY:
2933 /* If we modify the source of an elimination rule, disable it. */
2934 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2935 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2936 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2938 /* If we modify the target of an elimination rule by adding a constant,
2939 update its offset. If we modify the target in any other way, we'll
2940 have to disable the rule as well. */
2941 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
2942 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
2944 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mem_mode);
2946 /* If more bytes than MEM_MODE are pushed, account for them. */
2947 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2948 if (ep->to_rtx == stack_pointer_rtx)
2949 size = PUSH_ROUNDING (size);
2950 #endif
2951 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
2952 ep->offset += size;
2953 else if (code == PRE_INC || code == POST_INC)
2954 ep->offset -= size;
2955 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
2957 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
2958 && XEXP (x, 0) == XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0)
2959 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)))
2960 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1));
2961 else
2962 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
2966 /* These two aren't unary operators. */
2967 if (code == POST_MODIFY || code == PRE_MODIFY)
2968 break;
2970 /* Fall through to generic unary operation case. */
2971 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
2972 case NEG: case NOT:
2973 case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
2974 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2975 case FLOAT: case FIX:
2976 case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2977 case ABS:
2978 case SQRT:
2979 case FFS:
2980 case CLZ:
2981 case CTZ:
2982 case POPCOUNT:
2983 case PARITY:
2984 case BSWAP:
2985 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
2986 return;
2988 case SUBREG:
2989 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
2990 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2991 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
2992 && reg_equiv_memory_loc != 0
2993 && reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))] != 0)
2994 return;
2996 elimination_effects (SUBREG_REG (x), mem_mode);
2997 return;
2999 case USE:
3000 /* If using a register that is the source of an eliminate we still
3001 think can be performed, note it cannot be performed since we don't
3002 know how this register is used. */
3003 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3004 if (ep->from_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3005 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3007 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
3008 return;
3010 case CLOBBER:
3011 /* If clobbering a register that is the replacement register for an
3012 elimination we still think can be performed, note that it cannot
3013 be performed. Otherwise, we need not be concerned about it. */
3014 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3015 if (ep->to_rtx == XEXP (x, 0))
3016 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3018 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), mem_mode);
3019 return;
3021 case SET:
3022 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3023 if (REG_P (SET_DEST (x)))
3025 /* See if this is setting the replacement register for an
3026 elimination.
3028 If DEST is the hard frame pointer, we do nothing because we
3029 assume that all assignments to the frame pointer are for
3030 non-local gotos and are being done at a time when they are valid
3031 and do not disturb anything else. Some machines want to
3032 eliminate a fake argument pointer (or even a fake frame pointer)
3033 with either the real frame or the stack pointer. Assignments to
3034 the hard frame pointer must not prevent this elimination. */
3036 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3037 ep++)
3038 if (ep->to_rtx == SET_DEST (x)
3039 && SET_DEST (x) != hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
3041 /* If it is being incremented, adjust the offset. Otherwise,
3042 this elimination can't be done. */
3043 rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
3045 if (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
3046 && XEXP (src, 0) == SET_DEST (x)
3047 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
3048 ep->offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
3049 else
3050 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3054 elimination_effects (SET_DEST (x), 0);
3055 elimination_effects (SET_SRC (x), 0);
3056 return;
3058 case MEM:
3059 /* Our only special processing is to pass the mode of the MEM to our
3060 recursive call. */
3061 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
3062 return;
3064 default:
3065 break;
3068 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3069 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
3071 if (*fmt == 'e')
3072 elimination_effects (XEXP (x, i), mem_mode);
3073 else if (*fmt == 'E')
3074 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
3075 elimination_effects (XVECEXP (x, i, j), mem_mode);
3079 /* Descend through rtx X and verify that no references to eliminable registers
3080 remain. If any do remain, mark the involved register as not
3081 eliminable. */
3083 static void
3084 check_eliminable_occurrences (rtx x)
3086 const char *fmt;
3087 int i;
3088 enum rtx_code code;
3090 if (x == 0)
3091 return;
3093 code = GET_CODE (x);
3095 if (code == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3097 struct elim_table *ep;
3099 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3100 if (ep->from_rtx == x)
3101 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3102 return;
3105 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3106 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
3108 if (*fmt == 'e')
3109 check_eliminable_occurrences (XEXP (x, i));
3110 else if (*fmt == 'E')
3112 int j;
3113 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
3114 check_eliminable_occurrences (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
3119 /* Scan INSN and eliminate all eliminable registers in it.
3121 If REPLACE is nonzero, do the replacement destructively. Also
3122 delete the insn as dead it if it is setting an eliminable register.
3124 If REPLACE is zero, do all our allocations in reload_obstack.
3126 If no eliminations were done and this insn doesn't require any elimination
3127 processing (these are not identical conditions: it might be updating sp,
3128 but not referencing fp; this needs to be seen during reload_as_needed so
3129 that the offset between fp and sp can be taken into consideration), zero
3130 is returned. Otherwise, 1 is returned. */
3132 static int
3133 eliminate_regs_in_insn (rtx insn, int replace)
3135 int icode = recog_memoized (insn);
3136 rtx old_body = PATTERN (insn);
3137 int insn_is_asm = asm_noperands (old_body) >= 0;
3138 rtx old_set = single_set (insn);
3139 rtx new_body;
3140 int val = 0;
3141 int i;
3142 rtx substed_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3143 rtx orig_operand[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
3144 struct elim_table *ep;
3145 rtx plus_src, plus_cst_src;
3147 if (! insn_is_asm && icode < 0)
3149 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
3150 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
3151 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_VEC
3152 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC
3153 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == ASM_INPUT);
3154 return 0;
3157 if (old_set != 0 && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
3158 && REGNO (SET_DEST (old_set)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3160 /* Check for setting an eliminable register. */
3161 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3162 if (ep->from_rtx == SET_DEST (old_set) && ep->can_eliminate)
3164 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3165 /* If this is setting the frame pointer register to the
3166 hardware frame pointer register and this is an elimination
3167 that will be done (tested above), this insn is really
3168 adjusting the frame pointer downward to compensate for
3169 the adjustment done before a nonlocal goto. */
3170 if (ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3171 && ep->to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
3173 rtx base = SET_SRC (old_set);
3174 rtx base_insn = insn;
3175 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
3177 while (base != ep->to_rtx)
3179 rtx prev_insn, prev_set;
3181 if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS
3182 && GET_CODE (XEXP (base, 1)) == CONST_INT)
3184 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1));
3185 base = XEXP (base, 0);
3187 else if ((prev_insn = prev_nonnote_insn (base_insn)) != 0
3188 && (prev_set = single_set (prev_insn)) != 0
3189 && rtx_equal_p (SET_DEST (prev_set), base))
3191 base = SET_SRC (prev_set);
3192 base_insn = prev_insn;
3194 else
3195 break;
3198 if (base == ep->to_rtx)
3200 rtx src
3201 = plus_constant (ep->to_rtx, offset - ep->offset);
3203 new_body = old_body;
3204 if (! replace)
3206 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3207 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3208 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3210 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3211 old_set = single_set (insn);
3213 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we
3214 make the change. If not, keep the INSN_CODE
3215 the same and let reload fit it up. */
3216 validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), src, 1);
3217 validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (old_set),
3218 ep->to_rtx, 1);
3219 if (! apply_change_group ())
3221 SET_SRC (old_set) = src;
3222 SET_DEST (old_set) = ep->to_rtx;
3225 val = 1;
3226 goto done;
3229 #endif
3231 /* In this case this insn isn't serving a useful purpose. We
3232 will delete it in reload_as_needed once we know that this
3233 elimination is, in fact, being done.
3235 If REPLACE isn't set, we can't delete this insn, but needn't
3236 process it since it won't be used unless something changes. */
3237 if (replace)
3239 delete_dead_insn (insn);
3240 return 1;
3242 val = 1;
3243 goto done;
3247 /* We allow one special case which happens to work on all machines we
3248 currently support: a single set with the source or a REG_EQUAL
3249 note being a PLUS of an eliminable register and a constant. */
3250 plus_src = plus_cst_src = 0;
3251 if (old_set && REG_P (SET_DEST (old_set)))
3253 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS)
3254 plus_src = SET_SRC (old_set);
3255 /* First see if the source is of the form (plus (...) CST). */
3256 if (plus_src
3257 && GET_CODE (XEXP (plus_src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
3258 plus_cst_src = plus_src;
3259 else if (REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3260 || plus_src)
3262 /* Otherwise, see if we have a REG_EQUAL note of the form
3263 (plus (...) CST). */
3264 rtx links;
3265 for (links = REG_NOTES (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
3267 if ((REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUAL
3268 || REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_EQUIV)
3269 && GET_CODE (XEXP (links, 0)) == PLUS
3270 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (links, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
3272 plus_cst_src = XEXP (links, 0);
3273 break;
3278 /* Check that the first operand of the PLUS is a hard reg or
3279 the lowpart subreg of one. */
3280 if (plus_cst_src)
3282 rtx reg = XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0);
3283 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG && subreg_lowpart_p (reg))
3284 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
3286 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3287 plus_cst_src = 0;
3290 if (plus_cst_src)
3292 rtx reg = XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0);
3293 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INTVAL (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 1));
3295 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
3296 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
3298 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3299 if (ep->from_rtx == reg && ep->can_eliminate)
3301 rtx to_rtx = ep->to_rtx;
3302 offset += ep->offset;
3303 offset = trunc_int_for_mode (offset, GET_MODE (plus_cst_src));
3305 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0)) == SUBREG)
3306 to_rtx = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (XEXP (plus_cst_src, 0)),
3307 to_rtx);
3308 /* If we have a nonzero offset, and the source is already
3309 a simple REG, the following transformation would
3310 increase the cost of the insn by replacing a simple REG
3311 with (plus (reg sp) CST). So try only when we already
3312 had a PLUS before. */
3313 if (offset == 0 || plus_src)
3315 rtx new_src = plus_constant (to_rtx, offset);
3317 new_body = old_body;
3318 if (! replace)
3320 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3321 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3322 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3324 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3325 old_set = single_set (insn);
3327 /* First see if this insn remains valid when we make the
3328 change. If not, try to replace the whole pattern with
3329 a simple set (this may help if the original insn was a
3330 PARALLEL that was only recognized as single_set due to
3331 REG_UNUSED notes). If this isn't valid either, keep
3332 the INSN_CODE the same and let reload fix it up. */
3333 if (!validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (old_set), new_src, 0))
3335 rtx new_pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
3336 SET_DEST (old_set), new_src);
3338 if (!validate_change (insn, &PATTERN (insn), new_pat, 0))
3339 SET_SRC (old_set) = new_src;
3342 else
3343 break;
3345 val = 1;
3346 /* This can't have an effect on elimination offsets, so skip right
3347 to the end. */
3348 goto done;
3352 /* Determine the effects of this insn on elimination offsets. */
3353 elimination_effects (old_body, 0);
3355 /* Eliminate all eliminable registers occurring in operands that
3356 can be handled by reload. */
3357 extract_insn (insn);
3358 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3360 orig_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3361 substed_operand[i] = recog_data.operand[i];
3363 /* For an asm statement, every operand is eliminable. */
3364 if (insn_is_asm || insn_data[icode].operand[i].eliminable)
3366 bool is_set_src, in_plus;
3368 /* Check for setting a register that we know about. */
3369 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3370 && REG_P (orig_operand[i]))
3372 /* If we are assigning to a register that can be eliminated, it
3373 must be as part of a PARALLEL, since the code above handles
3374 single SETs. We must indicate that we can no longer
3375 eliminate this reg. */
3376 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS];
3377 ep++)
3378 if (ep->from_rtx == orig_operand[i])
3379 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3382 /* Companion to the above plus substitution, we can allow
3383 invariants as the source of a plain move. */
3384 is_set_src = false;
3385 if (old_set && recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &SET_SRC (old_set))
3386 is_set_src = true;
3387 in_plus = false;
3388 if (plus_src
3389 && (recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 0)
3390 || recog_data.operand_loc[i] == &XEXP (plus_src, 1)))
3391 in_plus = true;
3393 substed_operand[i]
3394 = eliminate_regs_1 (recog_data.operand[i], 0,
3395 replace ? insn : NULL_RTX,
3396 is_set_src || in_plus);
3397 if (substed_operand[i] != orig_operand[i])
3398 val = 1;
3399 /* Terminate the search in check_eliminable_occurrences at
3400 this point. */
3401 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = 0;
3403 /* If an output operand changed from a REG to a MEM and INSN is an
3404 insn, write a CLOBBER insn. */
3405 if (recog_data.operand_type[i] != OP_IN
3406 && REG_P (orig_operand[i])
3407 && MEM_P (substed_operand[i])
3408 && replace)
3409 emit_insn_after (gen_clobber (orig_operand[i]), insn);
3413 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3414 *recog_data.dup_loc[i]
3415 = *recog_data.operand_loc[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3417 /* If any eliminable remain, they aren't eliminable anymore. */
3418 check_eliminable_occurrences (old_body);
3420 /* Substitute the operands; the new values are in the substed_operand
3421 array. */
3422 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3423 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = substed_operand[i];
3424 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3425 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = substed_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3427 /* If we are replacing a body that was a (set X (plus Y Z)), try to
3428 re-recognize the insn. We do this in case we had a simple addition
3429 but now can do this as a load-address. This saves an insn in this
3430 common case.
3431 If re-recognition fails, the old insn code number will still be used,
3432 and some register operands may have changed into PLUS expressions.
3433 These will be handled by find_reloads by loading them into a register
3434 again. */
3436 if (val)
3438 /* If we aren't replacing things permanently and we changed something,
3439 make another copy to ensure that all the RTL is new. Otherwise
3440 things can go wrong if find_reload swaps commutative operands
3441 and one is inside RTL that has been copied while the other is not. */
3442 new_body = old_body;
3443 if (! replace)
3445 new_body = copy_insn (old_body);
3446 if (REG_NOTES (insn))
3447 REG_NOTES (insn) = copy_insn_1 (REG_NOTES (insn));
3449 PATTERN (insn) = new_body;
3451 /* If we had a move insn but now we don't, rerecognize it. This will
3452 cause spurious re-recognition if the old move had a PARALLEL since
3453 the new one still will, but we can't call single_set without
3454 having put NEW_BODY into the insn and the re-recognition won't
3455 hurt in this rare case. */
3456 /* ??? Why this huge if statement - why don't we just rerecognize the
3457 thing always? */
3458 if (! insn_is_asm
3459 && old_set != 0
3460 && ((REG_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3461 && (GET_CODE (new_body) != SET
3462 || !REG_P (SET_SRC (new_body))))
3463 /* If this was a load from or store to memory, compare
3464 the MEM in recog_data.operand to the one in the insn.
3465 If they are not equal, then rerecognize the insn. */
3466 || (old_set != 0
3467 && ((MEM_P (SET_SRC (old_set))
3468 && SET_SRC (old_set) != recog_data.operand[1])
3469 || (MEM_P (SET_DEST (old_set))
3470 && SET_DEST (old_set) != recog_data.operand[0])))
3471 /* If this was an add insn before, rerecognize. */
3472 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (old_set)) == PLUS))
3474 int new_icode = recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, 0);
3475 if (new_icode >= 0)
3476 INSN_CODE (insn) = new_icode;
3480 /* Restore the old body. If there were any changes to it, we made a copy
3481 of it while the changes were still in place, so we'll correctly return
3482 a modified insn below. */
3483 if (! replace)
3485 /* Restore the old body. */
3486 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_operands; i++)
3487 *recog_data.operand_loc[i] = orig_operand[i];
3488 for (i = 0; i < recog_data.n_dups; i++)
3489 *recog_data.dup_loc[i] = orig_operand[(int) recog_data.dup_num[i]];
3492 /* Update all elimination pairs to reflect the status after the current
3493 insn. The changes we make were determined by the earlier call to
3494 elimination_effects.
3496 We also detect cases where register elimination cannot be done,
3497 namely, if a register would be both changed and referenced outside a MEM
3498 in the resulting insn since such an insn is often undefined and, even if
3499 not, we cannot know what meaning will be given to it. Note that it is
3500 valid to have a register used in an address in an insn that changes it
3501 (presumably with a pre- or post-increment or decrement).
3503 If anything changes, return nonzero. */
3505 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3507 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset && ep->ref_outside_mem)
3508 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3510 ep->ref_outside_mem = 0;
3512 if (ep->previous_offset != ep->offset)
3513 val = 1;
3516 done:
3517 /* If we changed something, perform elimination in REG_NOTES. This is
3518 needed even when REPLACE is zero because a REG_DEAD note might refer
3519 to a register that we eliminate and could cause a different number
3520 of spill registers to be needed in the final reload pass than in
3521 the pre-passes. */
3522 if (val && REG_NOTES (insn) != 0)
3523 REG_NOTES (insn)
3524 = eliminate_regs_1 (REG_NOTES (insn), 0, REG_NOTES (insn), true);
3526 return val;
3529 /* Loop through all elimination pairs.
3530 Recalculate the number not at initial offset.
3532 Compute the maximum offset (minimum offset if the stack does not
3533 grow downward) for each elimination pair. */
3535 static void
3536 update_eliminable_offsets (void)
3538 struct elim_table *ep;
3540 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3541 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3543 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset;
3544 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3545 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3549 /* Given X, a SET or CLOBBER of DEST, if DEST is the target of a register
3550 replacement we currently believe is valid, mark it as not eliminable if X
3551 modifies DEST in any way other than by adding a constant integer to it.
3553 If DEST is the frame pointer, we do nothing because we assume that
3554 all assignments to the hard frame pointer are nonlocal gotos and are being
3555 done at a time when they are valid and do not disturb anything else.
3556 Some machines want to eliminate a fake argument pointer with either the
3557 frame or stack pointer. Assignments to the hard frame pointer must not
3558 prevent this elimination.
3560 Called via note_stores from reload before starting its passes to scan
3561 the insns of the function. */
3563 static void
3564 mark_not_eliminable (rtx dest, const_rtx x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3566 unsigned int i;
3568 /* A SUBREG of a hard register here is just changing its mode. We should
3569 not see a SUBREG of an eliminable hard register, but check just in
3570 case. */
3571 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
3572 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
3574 if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
3575 return;
3577 for (i = 0; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; i++)
3578 if (reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate && dest == reg_eliminate[i].to_rtx
3579 && (GET_CODE (x) != SET
3580 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != PLUS
3581 || XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0) != dest
3582 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)) != CONST_INT))
3584 reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate_previous
3585 = reg_eliminate[i].can_eliminate = 0;
3586 num_eliminable--;
3590 /* Verify that the initial elimination offsets did not change since the
3591 last call to set_initial_elim_offsets. This is used to catch cases
3592 where something illegal happened during reload_as_needed that could
3593 cause incorrect code to be generated if we did not check for it. */
3595 static bool
3596 verify_initial_elim_offsets (void)
3598 HOST_WIDE_INT t;
3600 if (!num_eliminable)
3601 return true;
3603 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3605 struct elim_table *ep;
3607 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3609 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, t);
3610 if (t != ep->initial_offset)
3611 return false;
3614 #else
3615 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (t);
3616 if (t != reg_eliminate[0].initial_offset)
3617 return false;
3618 #endif
3620 return true;
3623 /* Reset all offsets on eliminable registers to their initial values. */
3625 static void
3626 set_initial_elim_offsets (void)
3628 struct elim_table *ep = reg_eliminate;
3630 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3631 for (; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3633 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (ep->from, ep->to, ep->initial_offset);
3634 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3636 #else
3637 INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (ep->initial_offset);
3638 ep->previous_offset = ep->offset = ep->initial_offset;
3639 #endif
3641 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3644 /* Subroutine of set_initial_label_offsets called via for_each_eh_label. */
3646 static void
3647 set_initial_eh_label_offset (rtx label)
3649 set_label_offsets (label, NULL_RTX, 1);
3652 /* Initialize the known label offsets.
3653 Set a known offset for each forced label to be at the initial offset
3654 of each elimination. We do this because we assume that all
3655 computed jumps occur from a location where each elimination is
3656 at its initial offset.
3657 For all other labels, show that we don't know the offsets. */
3659 static void
3660 set_initial_label_offsets (void)
3662 rtx x;
3663 memset (offsets_known_at, 0, num_labels);
3665 for (x = forced_labels; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
3666 if (XEXP (x, 0))
3667 set_label_offsets (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, 1);
3669 for_each_eh_label (set_initial_eh_label_offset);
3672 /* Set all elimination offsets to the known values for the code label given
3673 by INSN. */
3675 static void
3676 set_offsets_for_label (rtx insn)
3678 unsigned int i;
3679 int label_nr = CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn);
3680 struct elim_table *ep;
3682 num_not_at_initial_offset = 0;
3683 for (i = 0, ep = reg_eliminate; i < NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS; ep++, i++)
3685 ep->offset = ep->previous_offset
3686 = offsets_at[label_nr - first_label_num][i];
3687 if (ep->can_eliminate && ep->offset != ep->initial_offset)
3688 num_not_at_initial_offset++;
3692 /* See if anything that happened changes which eliminations are valid.
3693 For example, on the SPARC, whether or not the frame pointer can
3694 be eliminated can depend on what registers have been used. We need
3695 not check some conditions again (such as flag_omit_frame_pointer)
3696 since they can't have changed. */
3698 static void
3699 update_eliminables (HARD_REG_SET *pset)
3701 int previous_frame_pointer_needed = frame_pointer_needed;
3702 struct elim_table *ep;
3704 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3705 if ((ep->from == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED)
3706 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3707 || ! CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
3708 #endif
3710 ep->can_eliminate = 0;
3712 /* Look for the case where we have discovered that we can't replace
3713 register A with register B and that means that we will now be
3714 trying to replace register A with register C. This means we can
3715 no longer replace register C with register B and we need to disable
3716 such an elimination, if it exists. This occurs often with A == ap,
3717 B == sp, and C == fp. */
3719 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3721 struct elim_table *op;
3722 int new_to = -1;
3724 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3726 /* Find the current elimination for ep->from, if there is a
3727 new one. */
3728 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3729 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3730 if (op->from == ep->from && op->can_eliminate)
3732 new_to = op->to;
3733 break;
3736 /* See if there is an elimination of NEW_TO -> EP->TO. If so,
3737 disable it. */
3738 for (op = reg_eliminate;
3739 op < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; op++)
3740 if (op->from == new_to && op->to == ep->to)
3741 op->can_eliminate = 0;
3745 /* See if any registers that we thought we could eliminate the previous
3746 time are no longer eliminable. If so, something has changed and we
3747 must spill the register. Also, recompute the number of eliminable
3748 registers and see if the frame pointer is needed; it is if there is
3749 no elimination of the frame pointer that we can perform. */
3751 frame_pointer_needed = 1;
3752 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3754 if (ep->can_eliminate
3755 && ep->from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3756 && ep->to != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3757 && (! SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
3758 || ! crtl->stack_realign_needed))
3759 frame_pointer_needed = 0;
3761 if (! ep->can_eliminate && ep->can_eliminate_previous)
3763 ep->can_eliminate_previous = 0;
3764 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, ep->from);
3765 num_eliminable--;
3769 /* If we didn't need a frame pointer last time, but we do now, spill
3770 the hard frame pointer. */
3771 if (frame_pointer_needed && ! previous_frame_pointer_needed)
3772 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (*pset, HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
3775 /* Return true if X is used as the target register of an elimination. */
3777 bool
3778 elimination_target_reg_p (rtx x)
3780 struct elim_table *ep;
3782 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3783 if (ep->to_rtx == x && ep->can_eliminate)
3784 return true;
3786 return false;
3789 /* Initialize the table of registers to eliminate.
3790 Pre-condition: global flag frame_pointer_needed has been set before
3791 calling this function. */
3793 static void
3794 init_elim_table (void)
3796 struct elim_table *ep;
3797 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3798 const struct elim_table_1 *ep1;
3799 #endif
3801 if (!reg_eliminate)
3802 reg_eliminate = XCNEWVEC (struct elim_table, NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS);
3804 num_eliminable = 0;
3806 #ifdef ELIMINABLE_REGS
3807 for (ep = reg_eliminate, ep1 = reg_eliminate_1;
3808 ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++, ep1++)
3810 ep->from = ep1->from;
3811 ep->to = ep1->to;
3812 ep->can_eliminate = ep->can_eliminate_previous
3813 = (CAN_ELIMINATE (ep->from, ep->to)
3814 && ! (ep->to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3815 && frame_pointer_needed
3816 && (! SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
3817 || ! stack_realign_fp)));
3819 #else
3820 reg_eliminate[0].from = reg_eliminate_1[0].from;
3821 reg_eliminate[0].to = reg_eliminate_1[0].to;
3822 reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate = reg_eliminate[0].can_eliminate_previous
3823 = ! frame_pointer_needed;
3824 #endif
3826 /* Count the number of eliminable registers and build the FROM and TO
3827 REG rtx's. Note that code in gen_rtx_REG will cause, e.g.,
3828 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) to equal stack_pointer_rtx.
3829 We depend on this. */
3830 for (ep = reg_eliminate; ep < &reg_eliminate[NUM_ELIMINABLE_REGS]; ep++)
3832 num_eliminable += ep->can_eliminate;
3833 ep->from_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->from);
3834 ep->to_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ep->to);
3838 /* Kick all pseudos out of hard register REGNO.
3840 If CANT_ELIMINATE is nonzero, it means that we are doing this spill
3841 because we found we can't eliminate some register. In the case, no pseudos
3842 are allowed to be in the register, even if they are only in a block that
3843 doesn't require spill registers, unlike the case when we are spilling this
3844 hard reg to produce another spill register.
3846 Return nonzero if any pseudos needed to be kicked out. */
3848 static void
3849 spill_hard_reg (unsigned int regno, int cant_eliminate)
3851 int i;
3853 if (cant_eliminate)
3855 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (bad_spill_regs_global, regno);
3856 df_set_regs_ever_live (regno, true);
3859 /* Spill every pseudo reg that was allocated to this reg
3860 or to something that overlaps this reg. */
3862 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < max_regno; i++)
3863 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0
3864 && (unsigned int) reg_renumber[i] <= regno
3865 && end_hard_regno (PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (i), reg_renumber[i]) > regno)
3866 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
3869 /* After find_reload_regs has been run for all insn that need reloads,
3870 and/or spill_hard_regs was called, this function is used to actually
3871 spill pseudo registers and try to reallocate them. It also sets up the
3872 spill_regs array for use by choose_reload_regs. */
3874 static int
3875 finish_spills (int global)
3877 struct insn_chain *chain;
3878 int something_changed = 0;
3879 unsigned i;
3880 reg_set_iterator rsi;
3882 /* Build the spill_regs array for the function. */
3883 /* If there are some registers still to eliminate and one of the spill regs
3884 wasn't ever used before, additional stack space may have to be
3885 allocated to store this register. Thus, we may have changed the offset
3886 between the stack and frame pointers, so mark that something has changed.
3888 One might think that we need only set VAL to 1 if this is a call-used
3889 register. However, the set of registers that must be saved by the
3890 prologue is not identical to the call-used set. For example, the
3891 register used by the call insn for the return PC is a call-used register,
3892 but must be saved by the prologue. */
3894 n_spills = 0;
3895 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
3896 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (used_spill_regs, i))
3898 spill_reg_order[i] = n_spills;
3899 spill_regs[n_spills++] = i;
3900 if (num_eliminable && ! df_regs_ever_live_p (i))
3901 something_changed = 1;
3902 df_set_regs_ever_live (i, true);
3904 else
3905 spill_reg_order[i] = -1;
3907 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
3908 if (! flag_ira || ! ira_conflicts_p || reg_renumber[i] >= 0)
3910 /* Record the current hard register the pseudo is allocated to
3911 in pseudo_previous_regs so we avoid reallocating it to the
3912 same hard reg in a later pass. */
3913 gcc_assert (reg_renumber[i] >= 0);
3915 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (pseudo_previous_regs[i], reg_renumber[i]);
3916 /* Mark it as no longer having a hard register home. */
3917 reg_renumber[i] = -1;
3918 if (flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p)
3919 /* Inform IRA about the change. */
3920 ira_mark_allocation_change (i);
3921 /* We will need to scan everything again. */
3922 something_changed = 1;
3925 /* Retry global register allocation if possible. */
3926 if (global)
3928 memset (pseudo_forbidden_regs, 0, max_regno * sizeof (HARD_REG_SET));
3929 /* For every insn that needs reloads, set the registers used as spill
3930 regs in pseudo_forbidden_regs for every pseudo live across the
3931 insn. */
3932 for (chain = insns_need_reload; chain; chain = chain->next_need_reload)
3934 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3935 (&chain->live_throughout, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
3937 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (pseudo_forbidden_regs[i],
3938 chain->used_spill_regs);
3940 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET
3941 (&chain->dead_or_set, FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER, i, rsi)
3943 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (pseudo_forbidden_regs[i],
3944 chain->used_spill_regs);
3948 if (! flag_ira || ! ira_conflicts_p)
3950 /* Retry allocating the spilled pseudos. For each reg,
3951 merge the various reg sets that indicate which hard regs
3952 can't be used, and call retry_global_alloc. We change
3953 spill_pseudos here to only contain pseudos that did not
3954 get a new hard register. */
3955 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < (unsigned)max_regno; i++)
3956 if (reg_old_renumber[i] != reg_renumber[i])
3958 HARD_REG_SET forbidden;
3960 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, bad_spill_regs_global);
3961 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, pseudo_forbidden_regs[i]);
3962 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (forbidden, pseudo_previous_regs[i]);
3963 retry_global_alloc (i, forbidden);
3964 if (reg_renumber[i] >= 0)
3965 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
3968 else
3970 /* Retry allocating the pseudos spilled in IRA and the
3971 reload. For each reg, merge the various reg sets that
3972 indicate which hard regs can't be used, and call
3973 ira_reassign_pseudos. */
3974 unsigned int n;
3976 for (n = 0, i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < (unsigned) max_regno; i++)
3977 if (reg_old_renumber[i] != reg_renumber[i])
3979 if (reg_renumber[i] < 0)
3980 temp_pseudo_reg_arr[n++] = i;
3981 else
3982 CLEAR_REGNO_REG_SET (&spilled_pseudos, i);
3984 if (ira_reassign_pseudos (temp_pseudo_reg_arr, n,
3985 bad_spill_regs_global,
3986 pseudo_forbidden_regs, pseudo_previous_regs,
3987 &spilled_pseudos))
3988 something_changed = 1;
3992 /* Fix up the register information in the insn chain.
3993 This involves deleting those of the spilled pseudos which did not get
3994 a new hard register home from the live_{before,after} sets. */
3995 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
3997 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos;
3998 HARD_REG_SET used_by_pseudos2;
4000 if (! flag_ira || ! ira_conflicts_p)
4002 /* Don't do it for IRA because IRA and the reload still can
4003 assign hard registers to the spilled pseudos on next
4004 reload iterations. */
4005 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->live_throughout, &spilled_pseudos);
4006 AND_COMPL_REG_SET (&chain->dead_or_set, &spilled_pseudos);
4008 /* Mark any unallocated hard regs as available for spills. That
4009 makes inheritance work somewhat better. */
4010 if (chain->need_reload)
4012 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
4013 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos2, &chain->dead_or_set);
4014 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (used_by_pseudos, used_by_pseudos2);
4016 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->live_throughout);
4017 compute_use_by_pseudos (&used_by_pseudos, &chain->dead_or_set);
4018 /* Value of chain->used_spill_regs from previous iteration
4019 may be not included in the value calculated here because
4020 of possible removing caller-saves insns (see function
4021 delete_caller_save_insns. */
4022 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_by_pseudos);
4023 AND_HARD_REG_SET (chain->used_spill_regs, used_spill_regs);
4027 CLEAR_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos);
4028 /* Let alter_reg modify the reg rtx's for the modified pseudos. */
4029 for (i = FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i < (unsigned)max_regno; i++)
4031 int regno = reg_renumber[i];
4032 if (reg_old_renumber[i] == regno)
4033 continue;
4035 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&changed_allocation_pseudos, i);
4037 alter_reg (i, reg_old_renumber[i], false);
4038 reg_old_renumber[i] = regno;
4039 if (dump_file)
4041 if (regno == -1)
4042 fprintf (dump_file, " Register %d now on stack.\n\n", i);
4043 else
4044 fprintf (dump_file, " Register %d now in %d.\n\n",
4045 i, reg_renumber[i]);
4049 return something_changed;
4052 /* Find all paradoxical subregs within X and update reg_max_ref_width. */
4054 static void
4055 scan_paradoxical_subregs (rtx x)
4057 int i;
4058 const char *fmt;
4059 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
4061 switch (code)
4063 case REG:
4064 case CONST_INT:
4065 case CONST:
4066 case SYMBOL_REF:
4067 case LABEL_REF:
4068 case CONST_DOUBLE:
4069 case CONST_FIXED:
4070 case CONST_VECTOR: /* shouldn't happen, but just in case. */
4071 case CC0:
4072 case PC:
4073 case USE:
4074 case CLOBBER:
4075 return;
4077 case SUBREG:
4078 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
4079 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
4080 > reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]))
4082 reg_max_ref_width[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x))]
4083 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x));
4084 mark_home_live_1 (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x)), GET_MODE (x));
4086 return;
4088 default:
4089 break;
4092 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
4093 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4095 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
4096 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XEXP (x, i));
4097 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
4099 int j;
4100 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
4101 scan_paradoxical_subregs (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
4106 /* A subroutine of reload_as_needed. If INSN has a REG_EH_REGION note,
4107 examine all of the reload insns between PREV and NEXT exclusive, and
4108 annotate all that may trap. */
4110 static void
4111 fixup_eh_region_note (rtx insn, rtx prev, rtx next)
4113 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX);
4114 unsigned int trap_count;
4115 rtx i;
4117 if (note == NULL)
4118 return;
4120 if (may_trap_p (PATTERN (insn)))
4121 trap_count = 1;
4122 else
4124 remove_note (insn, note);
4125 trap_count = 0;
4128 for (i = NEXT_INSN (prev); i != next; i = NEXT_INSN (i))
4129 if (INSN_P (i) && i != insn && may_trap_p (PATTERN (i)))
4131 trap_count++;
4132 add_reg_note (i, REG_EH_REGION, XEXP (note, 0));
4136 /* Reload pseudo-registers into hard regs around each insn as needed.
4137 Additional register load insns are output before the insn that needs it
4138 and perhaps store insns after insns that modify the reloaded pseudo reg.
4140 reg_last_reload_reg and reg_reloaded_contents keep track of
4141 which registers are already available in reload registers.
4142 We update these for the reloads that we perform,
4143 as the insns are scanned. */
4145 static void
4146 reload_as_needed (int live_known)
4148 struct insn_chain *chain;
4149 #if defined (AUTO_INC_DEC)
4150 int i;
4151 #endif
4152 rtx x;
4154 memset (spill_reg_rtx, 0, sizeof spill_reg_rtx);
4155 memset (spill_reg_store, 0, sizeof spill_reg_store);
4156 reg_last_reload_reg = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_regno);
4157 INIT_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload);
4158 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
4159 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered);
4161 set_initial_elim_offsets ();
4163 for (chain = reload_insn_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
4165 rtx prev = 0;
4166 rtx insn = chain->insn;
4167 rtx old_next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
4168 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
4169 rtx old_prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
4170 #endif
4172 /* If we pass a label, copy the offsets from the label information
4173 into the current offsets of each elimination. */
4174 if (LABEL_P (insn))
4175 set_offsets_for_label (insn);
4177 else if (INSN_P (insn))
4179 regset_head regs_to_forget;
4180 INIT_REG_SET (&regs_to_forget);
4181 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), forget_old_reloads_1, &regs_to_forget);
4183 /* If this is a USE and CLOBBER of a MEM, ensure that any
4184 references to eliminable registers have been removed. */
4186 if ((GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
4187 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
4188 && MEM_P (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)))
4189 XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0)
4190 = eliminate_regs (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0),
4191 GET_MODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)),
4192 NULL_RTX);
4194 /* If we need to do register elimination processing, do so.
4195 This might delete the insn, in which case we are done. */
4196 if ((num_eliminable || num_eliminable_invariants) && chain->need_elim)
4198 eliminate_regs_in_insn (insn, 1);
4199 if (NOTE_P (insn))
4201 update_eliminable_offsets ();
4202 CLEAR_REG_SET (&regs_to_forget);
4203 continue;
4207 /* If need_elim is nonzero but need_reload is zero, one might think
4208 that we could simply set n_reloads to 0. However, find_reloads
4209 could have done some manipulation of the insn (such as swapping
4210 commutative operands), and these manipulations are lost during
4211 the first pass for every insn that needs register elimination.
4212 So the actions of find_reloads must be redone here. */
4214 if (! chain->need_elim && ! chain->need_reload
4215 && ! chain->need_operand_change)
4216 n_reloads = 0;
4217 /* First find the pseudo regs that must be reloaded for this insn.
4218 This info is returned in the tables reload_... (see reload.h).
4219 Also modify the body of INSN by substituting RELOAD
4220 rtx's for those pseudo regs. */
4221 else
4223 CLEAR_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload);
4224 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_is_output_reload);
4226 find_reloads (insn, 1, spill_indirect_levels, live_known,
4227 spill_reg_order);
4230 if (n_reloads > 0)
4232 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
4233 rtx p;
4235 prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
4237 /* Now compute which reload regs to reload them into. Perhaps
4238 reusing reload regs from previous insns, or else output
4239 load insns to reload them. Maybe output store insns too.
4240 Record the choices of reload reg in reload_reg_rtx. */
4241 choose_reload_regs (chain);
4243 /* Merge any reloads that we didn't combine for fear of
4244 increasing the number of spill registers needed but now
4245 discover can be safely merged. */
4246 if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
4247 merge_assigned_reloads (insn);
4249 /* Generate the insns to reload operands into or out of
4250 their reload regs. */
4251 emit_reload_insns (chain);
4253 /* Substitute the chosen reload regs from reload_reg_rtx
4254 into the insn's body (or perhaps into the bodies of other
4255 load and store insn that we just made for reloading
4256 and that we moved the structure into). */
4257 subst_reloads (insn);
4259 /* Adjust the exception region notes for loads and stores. */
4260 if (flag_non_call_exceptions && !CALL_P (insn))
4261 fixup_eh_region_note (insn, prev, next);
4263 /* If this was an ASM, make sure that all the reload insns
4264 we have generated are valid. If not, give an error
4265 and delete them. */
4266 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) >= 0)
4267 for (p = NEXT_INSN (prev); p != next; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
4268 if (p != insn && INSN_P (p)
4269 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (p)) != USE
4270 && (recog_memoized (p) < 0
4271 || (extract_insn (p), ! constrain_operands (1))))
4273 error_for_asm (insn,
4274 "%<asm%> operand requires "
4275 "impossible reload");
4276 delete_insn (p);
4280 if (num_eliminable && chain->need_elim)
4281 update_eliminable_offsets ();
4283 /* Any previously reloaded spilled pseudo reg, stored in this insn,
4284 is no longer validly lying around to save a future reload.
4285 Note that this does not detect pseudos that were reloaded
4286 for this insn in order to be stored in
4287 (obeying register constraints). That is correct; such reload
4288 registers ARE still valid. */
4289 forget_marked_reloads (&regs_to_forget);
4290 CLEAR_REG_SET (&regs_to_forget);
4292 /* There may have been CLOBBER insns placed after INSN. So scan
4293 between INSN and NEXT and use them to forget old reloads. */
4294 for (x = NEXT_INSN (insn); x != old_next; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
4295 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (x) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (x)) == CLOBBER)
4296 note_stores (PATTERN (x), forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
4298 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
4299 /* Likewise for regs altered by auto-increment in this insn.
4300 REG_INC notes have been changed by reloading:
4301 find_reloads_address_1 records substitutions for them,
4302 which have been performed by subst_reloads above. */
4303 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4305 rtx in_reg = rld[i].in_reg;
4306 if (in_reg)
4308 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (in_reg);
4309 /* PRE_INC / PRE_DEC will have the reload register ending up
4310 with the same value as the stack slot, but that doesn't
4311 hold true for POST_INC / POST_DEC. Either we have to
4312 convert the memory access to a true POST_INC / POST_DEC,
4313 or we can't use the reload register for inheritance. */
4314 if ((code == POST_INC || code == POST_DEC)
4315 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4316 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
4317 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4318 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4319 && ((unsigned) reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
4320 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
4323 rtx reload_reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
4324 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reload_reg);
4325 int n = 0;
4326 rtx p;
4328 for (p = PREV_INSN (old_next); p != prev; p = PREV_INSN (p))
4330 /* We really want to ignore REG_INC notes here, so
4331 use PATTERN (p) as argument to reg_set_p . */
4332 if (reg_set_p (reload_reg, PATTERN (p)))
4333 break;
4334 n = count_occurrences (PATTERN (p), reload_reg, 0);
4335 if (! n)
4336 continue;
4337 if (n == 1)
4339 n = validate_replace_rtx (reload_reg,
4340 gen_rtx_fmt_e (code,
4341 mode,
4342 reload_reg),
4345 /* We must also verify that the constraints
4346 are met after the replacement. */
4347 extract_insn (p);
4348 if (n)
4349 n = constrain_operands (1);
4350 else
4351 break;
4353 /* If the constraints were not met, then
4354 undo the replacement. */
4355 if (!n)
4357 validate_replace_rtx (gen_rtx_fmt_e (code,
4358 mode,
4359 reload_reg),
4360 reload_reg, p);
4361 break;
4365 break;
4367 if (n == 1)
4369 add_reg_note (p, REG_INC, reload_reg);
4370 /* Mark this as having an output reload so that the
4371 REG_INC processing code below won't invalidate
4372 the reload for inheritance. */
4373 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4374 REGNO (reload_reg));
4375 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
4376 REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0)));
4378 else
4379 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg, 0), NULL_RTX,
4380 NULL);
4382 else if ((code == PRE_INC || code == PRE_DEC)
4383 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4384 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx))
4385 /* Make sure it is the inc/dec pseudo, and not
4386 some other (e.g. output operand) pseudo. */
4387 && ((unsigned) reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx)]
4388 == REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0))))
4390 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
4391 REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx));
4392 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
4393 REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0)));
4395 else if ((code == PRE_INC || code == PRE_DEC
4396 || code == POST_INC || code == POST_DEC))
4398 int in_hard_regno;
4399 int in_regno = REGNO (XEXP (in_reg, 0));
4401 if (reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno] != NULL_RTX)
4403 in_hard_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno]);
4404 gcc_assert (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid,
4405 in_hard_regno));
4406 for (x = old_prev ? NEXT_INSN (old_prev) : insn;
4407 x != old_next;
4408 x = NEXT_INSN (x))
4409 if (x == reg_reloaded_insn[in_hard_regno])
4410 break;
4411 /* If for some reasons, we didn't set up
4412 reg_last_reload_reg in this insn,
4413 invalidate inheritance from previous
4414 insns for the incremented/decremented
4415 register. Such registers will be not in
4416 reg_has_output_reload. */
4417 if (x == old_next)
4418 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (in_reg, 0),
4419 NULL_RTX, NULL);
4424 /* If a pseudo that got a hard register is auto-incremented,
4425 we must purge records of copying it into pseudos without
4426 hard registers. */
4427 for (x = REG_NOTES (insn); x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
4428 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (x) == REG_INC)
4430 /* See if this pseudo reg was reloaded in this insn.
4431 If so, its last-reload info is still valid
4432 because it is based on this insn's reload. */
4433 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
4434 if (rld[i].out == XEXP (x, 0))
4435 break;
4437 if (i == n_reloads)
4438 forget_old_reloads_1 (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, NULL);
4440 #endif
4442 /* A reload reg's contents are unknown after a label. */
4443 if (LABEL_P (insn))
4444 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid);
4446 /* Don't assume a reload reg is still good after a call insn
4447 if it is a call-used reg, or if it contains a value that will
4448 be partially clobbered by the call. */
4449 else if (CALL_P (insn))
4451 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid, call_used_reg_set);
4452 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_valid, reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered);
4456 /* Clean up. */
4457 free (reg_last_reload_reg);
4458 CLEAR_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload);
4461 /* Discard all record of any value reloaded from X,
4462 or reloaded in X from someplace else;
4463 unless X is an output reload reg of the current insn.
4465 X may be a hard reg (the reload reg)
4466 or it may be a pseudo reg that was reloaded from.
4468 When DATA is non-NULL just mark the registers in regset
4469 to be forgotten later. */
4471 static void
4472 forget_old_reloads_1 (rtx x, const_rtx ignored ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4473 void *data)
4475 unsigned int regno;
4476 unsigned int nr;
4477 regset regs = (regset) data;
4479 /* note_stores does give us subregs of hard regs,
4480 subreg_regno_offset requires a hard reg. */
4481 while (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
4483 /* We ignore the subreg offset when calculating the regno,
4484 because we are using the entire underlying hard register
4485 below. */
4486 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
4489 if (!REG_P (x))
4490 return;
4492 regno = REGNO (x);
4494 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4495 nr = 1;
4496 else
4498 unsigned int i;
4500 nr = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (x)];
4501 /* Storing into a spilled-reg invalidates its contents.
4502 This can happen if a block-local pseudo is allocated to that reg
4503 and it wasn't spilled because this block's total need is 0.
4504 Then some insn might have an optional reload and use this reg. */
4505 if (!regs)
4506 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
4507 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4508 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4509 if (n_reloads == 0
4510 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, regno + i))
4512 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + i);
4513 spill_reg_store[regno + i] = 0;
4517 if (regs)
4518 while (nr-- > 0)
4519 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (regs, regno + nr);
4520 else
4522 /* Since value of X has changed,
4523 forget any value previously copied from it. */
4525 while (nr-- > 0)
4526 /* But don't forget a copy if this is the output reload
4527 that establishes the copy's validity. */
4528 if (n_reloads == 0
4529 || !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload, regno + nr))
4530 reg_last_reload_reg[regno + nr] = 0;
4534 /* Forget the reloads marked in regset by previous function. */
4535 static void
4536 forget_marked_reloads (regset regs)
4538 unsigned int reg;
4539 reg_set_iterator rsi;
4540 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (regs, 0, reg, rsi)
4542 if (reg < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4543 /* But don't do this if the reg actually serves as an output
4544 reload reg in the current instruction. */
4545 && (n_reloads == 0
4546 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, reg)))
4548 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reg);
4549 spill_reg_store[reg] = 0;
4551 if (n_reloads == 0
4552 || !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload, reg))
4553 reg_last_reload_reg[reg] = 0;
4557 /* The following HARD_REG_SETs indicate when each hard register is
4558 used for a reload of various parts of the current insn. */
4560 /* If reg is unavailable for all reloads. */
4561 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_unavailable;
4562 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for a RELOAD_OTHER reload. */
4563 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used;
4564 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4565 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4566 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4567 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4568 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4569 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4570 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload for operand I. */
4571 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4572 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for operand I. */
4573 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_input[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4574 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload for operand I. */
4575 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_output[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
4576 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload. */
4577 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
4578 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload. */
4579 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
4580 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_INSN reload. */
4581 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_insn;
4582 /* If reg is in use for a RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reload. */
4583 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
4585 /* If reg is in use as a reload reg for any sort of reload. */
4586 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_at_all;
4588 /* If reg is use as an inherited reload. We just mark the first register
4589 in the group. */
4590 static HARD_REG_SET reload_reg_used_for_inherit;
4592 /* Records which hard regs are used in any way, either as explicit use or
4593 by being allocated to a pseudo during any point of the current insn. */
4594 static HARD_REG_SET reg_used_in_insn;
4596 /* Mark reg REGNO as in use for a reload of the sort spec'd by OPNUM and
4597 TYPE. MODE is used to indicate how many consecutive regs are
4598 actually used. */
4600 static void
4601 mark_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type,
4602 enum machine_mode mode)
4604 unsigned int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
4605 unsigned int i;
4607 for (i = regno; i < nregs + regno; i++)
4609 switch (type)
4611 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4612 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, i);
4613 break;
4615 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4616 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], i);
4617 break;
4619 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4620 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4621 break;
4623 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4624 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], i);
4625 break;
4627 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4628 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], i);
4629 break;
4631 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4632 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, i);
4633 break;
4635 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4636 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, i);
4637 break;
4639 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4640 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, i);
4641 break;
4643 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4644 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum], i);
4645 break;
4647 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4648 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum], i);
4649 break;
4651 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4652 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, i);
4653 break;
4656 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all, i);
4660 /* Similarly, but show REGNO is no longer in use for a reload. */
4662 static void
4663 clear_reload_reg_in_use (unsigned int regno, int opnum,
4664 enum reload_type type, enum machine_mode mode)
4666 unsigned int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
4667 unsigned int start_regno, end_regno, r;
4668 int i;
4669 /* A complication is that for some reload types, inheritance might
4670 allow multiple reloads of the same types to share a reload register.
4671 We set check_opnum if we have to check only reloads with the same
4672 operand number, and check_any if we have to check all reloads. */
4673 int check_opnum = 0;
4674 int check_any = 0;
4675 HARD_REG_SET *used_in_set;
4677 switch (type)
4679 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4680 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used;
4681 break;
4683 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4684 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum];
4685 break;
4687 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4688 check_opnum = 1;
4689 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum];
4690 break;
4692 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4693 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum];
4694 break;
4696 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4697 check_opnum = 1;
4698 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum];
4699 break;
4701 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4702 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr;
4703 break;
4705 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4706 check_any = 1;
4707 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload;
4708 break;
4710 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4711 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_other_addr;
4712 check_any = 1;
4713 break;
4715 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4716 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_input[opnum];
4717 break;
4719 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4720 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_output[opnum];
4721 break;
4723 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4724 used_in_set = &reload_reg_used_in_insn;
4725 break;
4726 default:
4727 gcc_unreachable ();
4729 /* We resolve conflicts with remaining reloads of the same type by
4730 excluding the intervals of reload registers by them from the
4731 interval of freed reload registers. Since we only keep track of
4732 one set of interval bounds, we might have to exclude somewhat
4733 more than what would be necessary if we used a HARD_REG_SET here.
4734 But this should only happen very infrequently, so there should
4735 be no reason to worry about it. */
4737 start_regno = regno;
4738 end_regno = regno + nregs;
4739 if (check_opnum || check_any)
4741 for (i = n_reloads - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4743 if (rld[i].when_needed == type
4744 && (check_any || rld[i].opnum == opnum)
4745 && rld[i].reg_rtx)
4747 unsigned int conflict_start = true_regnum (rld[i].reg_rtx);
4748 unsigned int conflict_end
4749 = end_hard_regno (rld[i].mode, conflict_start);
4751 /* If there is an overlap with the first to-be-freed register,
4752 adjust the interval start. */
4753 if (conflict_start <= start_regno && conflict_end > start_regno)
4754 start_regno = conflict_end;
4755 /* Otherwise, if there is a conflict with one of the other
4756 to-be-freed registers, adjust the interval end. */
4757 if (conflict_start > start_regno && conflict_start < end_regno)
4758 end_regno = conflict_start;
4763 for (r = start_regno; r < end_regno; r++)
4764 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*used_in_set, r);
4767 /* 1 if reg REGNO is free as a reload reg for a reload of the sort
4768 specified by OPNUM and TYPE. */
4770 static int
4771 reload_reg_free_p (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
4773 int i;
4775 /* In use for a RELOAD_OTHER means it's not available for anything. */
4776 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno)
4777 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
4778 return 0;
4780 switch (type)
4782 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4783 /* In use for anything means we can't use it for RELOAD_OTHER. */
4784 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno)
4785 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4786 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno)
4787 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
4788 return 0;
4790 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4791 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4792 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4793 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4794 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4795 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
4796 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4797 return 0;
4799 return 1;
4801 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
4802 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4803 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno))
4804 return 0;
4806 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
4807 return 0;
4809 /* If it is used for some other input, can't use it. */
4810 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4811 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4812 return 0;
4814 /* If it is used in a later operand's address, can't use it. */
4815 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4816 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4817 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
4818 return 0;
4820 return 1;
4822 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4823 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address for this
4824 operand or used as an input in an earlier one. */
4825 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[opnum], regno)
4826 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4827 return 0;
4829 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
4830 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4831 return 0;
4833 return 1;
4835 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4836 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an input address
4837 for this operand or used as an input in an earlier
4838 one. */
4839 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4840 return 0;
4842 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
4843 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4844 return 0;
4846 return 1;
4848 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
4849 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address for this
4850 operand or used as an output in this or a later operand. Note
4851 that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order, so
4852 the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
4853 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[opnum], regno))
4854 return 0;
4856 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
4857 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4858 return 0;
4860 return 1;
4862 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
4863 /* Can't use a register if it is used for an output address
4864 for this operand or used as an output in this or a
4865 later operand. Note that multiple output operands are
4866 emitted in reverse order, so the conflicting ones are
4867 those with lower indices. */
4868 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[opnum], regno))
4869 return 0;
4871 for (i = 0; i <= opnum; i++)
4872 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4873 return 0;
4875 return 1;
4877 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
4878 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4879 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4880 return 0;
4882 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4883 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
4885 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
4886 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4887 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4888 return 0;
4890 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno));
4892 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
4893 /* This cannot share a register with RELOAD_FOR_INSN reloads, other
4894 outputs, or an operand address for this or an earlier output.
4895 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
4896 so the conflicting ones are those with higher indices. */
4897 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno))
4898 return 0;
4900 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4901 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4902 return 0;
4904 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4905 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4906 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
4907 return 0;
4909 return 1;
4911 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
4912 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4913 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno)
4914 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4915 return 0;
4917 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4918 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno));
4920 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4921 return ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr, regno);
4923 default:
4924 gcc_unreachable ();
4928 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
4929 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
4930 is still available in REGNO at the end of the insn.
4932 We can assume that the reload reg was already tested for availability
4933 at the time it is needed, and we should not check this again,
4934 in case the reg has already been marked in use. */
4936 static int
4937 reload_reg_reaches_end_p (unsigned int regno, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
4939 int i;
4941 switch (type)
4943 case RELOAD_OTHER:
4944 /* Since a RELOAD_OTHER reload claims the reg for the entire insn,
4945 its value must reach the end. */
4946 return 1;
4948 /* If this use is for part of the insn,
4949 its value reaches if no subsequent part uses the same register.
4950 Just like the above function, don't try to do this with lots
4951 of fallthroughs. */
4953 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
4954 /* Here we check for everything else, since these don't conflict
4955 with anything else and everything comes later. */
4957 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4958 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4959 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4960 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno)
4961 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4962 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
4963 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4964 return 0;
4966 return (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4967 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno)
4968 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4969 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
4971 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
4972 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
4973 /* Similar, except that we check only for this and subsequent inputs
4974 and the address of only subsequent inputs and we do not need
4975 to check for RELOAD_OTHER objects since they are known not to
4976 conflict. */
4978 for (i = opnum; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4979 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
4980 return 0;
4982 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4983 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
4984 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno))
4985 return 0;
4987 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
4988 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
4989 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
4990 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
4991 return 0;
4993 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload, regno))
4994 return 0;
4996 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
4997 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
4998 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5000 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5001 /* Similar to input address, except we start at the next operand for
5002 both input and input address and we do not check for
5003 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INSN since these
5004 would conflict. */
5006 for (i = opnum + 1; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5007 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i], regno)
5008 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i], regno)
5009 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_input[i], regno))
5010 return 0;
5012 /* ... fall through ... */
5014 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5015 /* Check outputs and their addresses. */
5017 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5018 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5019 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5020 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5021 return 0;
5023 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5025 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5026 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5027 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5028 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno)
5029 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output[i], regno))
5030 return 0;
5032 return (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr, regno)
5033 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_insn, regno)
5034 && !TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regno));
5036 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5037 /* These conflict with other outputs with RELOAD_OTHER. So
5038 we need only check for output addresses. */
5040 opnum = reload_n_operands;
5042 /* ... fall through ... */
5044 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5045 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5046 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5047 /* We already know these can't conflict with a later output. So the
5048 only thing to check are later output addresses.
5049 Note that multiple output operands are emitted in reverse order,
5050 so the conflicting ones are those with lower indices. */
5051 for (i = 0; i < opnum; i++)
5052 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i], regno)
5053 || TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i], regno))
5054 return 0;
5056 return 1;
5058 default:
5059 gcc_unreachable ();
5063 /* Like reload_reg_reaches_end_p, but check that the condition holds for
5064 every register in the range [REGNO, REGNO + NREGS). */
5066 static bool
5067 reload_regs_reach_end_p (unsigned int regno, int nregs,
5068 int opnum, enum reload_type type)
5070 int i;
5072 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
5073 if (!reload_reg_reaches_end_p (regno + i, opnum, type))
5074 return false;
5075 return true;
5079 /* Returns whether R1 and R2 are uniquely chained: the value of one
5080 is used by the other, and that value is not used by any other
5081 reload for this insn. This is used to partially undo the decision
5082 made in find_reloads when in the case of multiple
5083 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads it converts all
5084 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reloads into RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
5085 reloads. This code tries to avoid the conflict created by that
5086 change. It might be cleaner to explicitly keep track of which
5087 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR reload is associated with which
5088 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reload, rather than to try to detect
5089 this after the fact. */
5090 static bool
5091 reloads_unique_chain_p (int r1, int r2)
5093 int i;
5095 /* We only check input reloads. */
5096 if (! rld[r1].in || ! rld[r2].in)
5097 return false;
5099 /* Avoid anything with output reloads. */
5100 if (rld[r1].out || rld[r2].out)
5101 return false;
5103 /* "chained" means one reload is a component of the other reload,
5104 not the same as the other reload. */
5105 if (rld[r1].opnum != rld[r2].opnum
5106 || rtx_equal_p (rld[r1].in, rld[r2].in)
5107 || rld[r1].optional || rld[r2].optional
5108 || ! (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r1].in, rld[r2].in)
5109 || reg_mentioned_p (rld[r2].in, rld[r1].in)))
5110 return false;
5112 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i ++)
5113 /* Look for input reloads that aren't our two */
5114 if (i != r1 && i != r2 && rld[i].in)
5116 /* If our reload is mentioned at all, it isn't a simple chain. */
5117 if (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r1].in, rld[i].in))
5118 return false;
5120 return true;
5124 /* The recursive function change all occurrences of WHAT in *WHERE
5125 onto REPL. */
5126 static void
5127 substitute (rtx *where, const_rtx what, rtx repl)
5129 const char *fmt;
5130 int i;
5131 enum rtx_code code;
5133 if (*where == 0)
5134 return;
5136 if (*where == what || rtx_equal_p (*where, what))
5138 *where = repl;
5139 return;
5142 code = GET_CODE (*where);
5143 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
5144 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
5146 if (fmt[i] == 'E')
5148 int j;
5150 for (j = XVECLEN (*where, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
5151 substitute (&XVECEXP (*where, i, j), what, repl);
5153 else if (fmt[i] == 'e')
5154 substitute (&XEXP (*where, i), what, repl);
5158 /* The function returns TRUE if chain of reload R1 and R2 (in any
5159 order) can be evaluated without usage of intermediate register for
5160 the reload containing another reload. It is important to see
5161 gen_reload to understand what the function is trying to do. As an
5162 example, let us have reload chain
5164 r2: const
5165 r1: <something> + const
5167 and reload R2 got reload reg HR. The function returns true if
5168 there is a correct insn HR = HR + <something>. Otherwise,
5169 gen_reload will use intermediate register (and this is the reload
5170 reg for R1) to reload <something>.
5172 We need this function to find a conflict for chain reloads. In our
5173 example, if HR = HR + <something> is incorrect insn, then we cannot
5174 use HR as a reload register for R2. If we do use it then we get a
5175 wrong code:
5177 HR = const
5178 HR = <something>
5179 HR = HR + HR
5182 static bool
5183 gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p (int r1, int r2)
5185 bool result;
5186 int regno, n, code;
5187 rtx out, in, tem, insn;
5188 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
5190 /* Make r2 a component of r1. */
5191 if (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r1].in, rld[r2].in))
5193 n = r1;
5194 r1 = r2;
5195 r2 = n;
5197 gcc_assert (reg_mentioned_p (rld[r2].in, rld[r1].in));
5198 regno = rld[r1].regno >= 0 ? rld[r1].regno : rld[r2].regno;
5199 gcc_assert (regno >= 0);
5200 out = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r1].mode, regno);
5201 in = copy_rtx (rld[r1].in);
5202 substitute (&in, rld[r2].in, gen_rtx_REG (rld[r2].mode, regno));
5204 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
5205 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
5206 if (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG
5207 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (in))
5208 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in))))
5209 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in)), out)) != 0)
5210 in = SUBREG_REG (in), out = tem;
5212 if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
5213 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 0))
5214 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
5215 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 0)))
5216 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
5217 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
5218 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
5219 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 1))))
5221 insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
5222 code = recog_memoized (insn);
5223 result = false;
5225 if (code >= 0)
5227 extract_insn (insn);
5228 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in
5229 its validity determination, i.e., the way it would after
5230 reload has completed. */
5231 result = constrain_operands (1);
5234 delete_insns_since (last);
5235 return result;
5238 /* It looks like other cases in gen_reload are not possible for
5239 chain reloads or do need an intermediate hard registers. */
5240 return true;
5243 /* Return 1 if the reloads denoted by R1 and R2 cannot share a register.
5244 Return 0 otherwise.
5246 This function uses the same algorithm as reload_reg_free_p above. */
5248 static int
5249 reloads_conflict (int r1, int r2)
5251 enum reload_type r1_type = rld[r1].when_needed;
5252 enum reload_type r2_type = rld[r2].when_needed;
5253 int r1_opnum = rld[r1].opnum;
5254 int r2_opnum = rld[r2].opnum;
5256 /* RELOAD_OTHER conflicts with everything. */
5257 if (r2_type == RELOAD_OTHER)
5258 return 1;
5260 /* Otherwise, check conflicts differently for each type. */
5262 switch (r1_type)
5264 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5265 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
5266 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
5267 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR
5268 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
5269 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
5270 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
5271 && r2_opnum > r1_opnum));
5273 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5274 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
5275 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
5277 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5278 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS && r1_opnum == r2_opnum)
5279 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && r2_opnum < r1_opnum));
5281 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5282 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
5283 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
5285 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5286 return ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS && r2_opnum == r1_opnum)
5287 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT && r2_opnum <= r1_opnum));
5289 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5290 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
5291 || (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
5292 && (!reloads_unique_chain_p (r1, r2)
5293 || !gen_reload_chain_without_interm_reg_p (r1, r2))));
5295 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5296 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
5297 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR);
5299 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5300 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
5301 || ((r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
5302 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS)
5303 && r2_opnum >= r1_opnum));
5305 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5306 return (r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
5307 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_INSN
5308 || r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS);
5310 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5311 return r2_type == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS;
5313 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5314 return 1;
5316 default:
5317 gcc_unreachable ();
5321 /* Indexed by reload number, 1 if incoming value
5322 inherited from previous insns. */
5323 static char reload_inherited[MAX_RELOADS];
5325 /* For an inherited reload, this is the insn the reload was inherited from,
5326 if we know it. Otherwise, this is 0. */
5327 static rtx reload_inheritance_insn[MAX_RELOADS];
5329 /* If nonzero, this is a place to get the value of the reload,
5330 rather than using reload_in. */
5331 static rtx reload_override_in[MAX_RELOADS];
5333 /* For each reload, the hard register number of the register used,
5334 or -1 if we did not need a register for this reload. */
5335 static int reload_spill_index[MAX_RELOADS];
5337 /* Index X is the value of rld[X].reg_rtx, adjusted for the input mode. */
5338 static rtx reload_reg_rtx_for_input[MAX_RELOADS];
5340 /* Index X is the value of rld[X].reg_rtx, adjusted for the output mode. */
5341 static rtx reload_reg_rtx_for_output[MAX_RELOADS];
5343 /* Subroutine of free_for_value_p, used to check a single register.
5344 START_REGNO is the starting regno of the full reload register
5345 (possibly comprising multiple hard registers) that we are considering. */
5347 static int
5348 reload_reg_free_for_value_p (int start_regno, int regno, int opnum,
5349 enum reload_type type, rtx value, rtx out,
5350 int reloadnum, int ignore_address_reloads)
5352 int time1;
5353 /* Set if we see an input reload that must not share its reload register
5354 with any new earlyclobber, but might otherwise share the reload
5355 register with an output or input-output reload. */
5356 int check_earlyclobber = 0;
5357 int i;
5358 int copy = 0;
5360 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, regno))
5361 return 0;
5363 if (out == const0_rtx)
5365 copy = 1;
5366 out = NULL_RTX;
5369 /* We use some pseudo 'time' value to check if the lifetimes of the
5370 new register use would overlap with the one of a previous reload
5371 that is not read-only or uses a different value.
5372 The 'time' used doesn't have to be linear in any shape or form, just
5373 monotonic.
5374 Some reload types use different 'buckets' for each operand.
5375 So there are MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS different time values for each
5376 such reload type.
5377 We compute TIME1 as the time when the register for the prospective
5378 new reload ceases to be live, and TIME2 for each existing
5379 reload as the time when that the reload register of that reload
5380 becomes live.
5381 Where there is little to be gained by exact lifetime calculations,
5382 we just make conservative assumptions, i.e. a longer lifetime;
5383 this is done in the 'default:' cases. */
5384 switch (type)
5386 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5387 /* RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS conflicts with RELOAD_OTHER reloads. */
5388 time1 = copy ? 0 : 1;
5389 break;
5390 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5391 time1 = copy ? 1 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
5392 break;
5393 /* For each input, we may have a sequence of RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS,
5394 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_INPUT. By adding 0 / 1 / 2 ,
5395 respectively, to the time values for these, we get distinct time
5396 values. To get distinct time values for each operand, we have to
5397 multiply opnum by at least three. We round that up to four because
5398 multiply by four is often cheaper. */
5399 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5400 time1 = opnum * 4 + 2;
5401 break;
5402 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5403 time1 = opnum * 4 + 3;
5404 break;
5405 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5406 /* All RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reloads remain live till the instruction
5407 executes (inclusive). */
5408 time1 = copy ? opnum * 4 + 4 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5409 break;
5410 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5411 /* opnum * 4 + 4
5412 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS - 1) * 4 + 4 == MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 */
5413 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
5414 break;
5415 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5416 /* RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads are live even while the insn
5417 is executed. */
5418 time1 = copy ? MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2 : MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5419 break;
5420 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5421 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + opnum;
5422 break;
5423 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5424 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + opnum;
5425 break;
5426 default:
5427 time1 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 5 + 5;
5430 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5432 rtx reg = rld[i].reg_rtx;
5433 if (reg && REG_P (reg)
5434 && ((unsigned) regno - true_regnum (reg)
5435 <= hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (reg)][GET_MODE (reg)] - (unsigned) 1)
5436 && i != reloadnum)
5438 rtx other_input = rld[i].in;
5440 /* If the other reload loads the same input value, that
5441 will not cause a conflict only if it's loading it into
5442 the same register. */
5443 if (true_regnum (reg) != start_regno)
5444 other_input = NULL_RTX;
5445 if (! other_input || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)
5446 || rld[i].out || out)
5448 int time2;
5449 switch (rld[i].when_needed)
5451 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
5452 time2 = 0;
5453 break;
5454 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
5455 /* find_reloads makes sure that a
5456 RELOAD_FOR_{INP,OP,OUT}ADDR_ADDRESS reload is only used
5457 by at most one - the first -
5458 RELOAD_FOR_{INPUT,OPERAND,OUTPUT}_ADDRESS . If the
5459 address reload is inherited, the address address reload
5460 goes away, so we can ignore this conflict. */
5461 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5462 && ignore_address_reloads
5463 /* Unless the RELOAD_FOR_INPUT is an auto_inc expression.
5464 Then the address address is still needed to store
5465 back the new address. */
5466 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5467 continue;
5468 /* Likewise, if a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT can inherit a value, its
5469 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS
5470 reloads go away. */
5471 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
5472 && ignore_address_reloads
5473 /* Unless we are reloading an auto_inc expression. */
5474 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5475 continue;
5476 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 2;
5477 break;
5478 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
5479 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT && opnum == rld[i].opnum
5480 && ignore_address_reloads
5481 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5482 continue;
5483 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 3;
5484 break;
5485 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
5486 time2 = rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4;
5487 check_earlyclobber = 1;
5488 break;
5489 /* rld[i].opnum * 4 + 4 <= (MAX_RECOG_OPERAND - 1) * 4 + 4
5490 == MAX_RECOG_OPERAND * 4 */
5491 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
5492 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5493 && ignore_address_reloads
5494 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5495 continue;
5496 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 1;
5497 break;
5498 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
5499 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 2;
5500 check_earlyclobber = 1;
5501 break;
5502 case RELOAD_FOR_INSN:
5503 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5504 break;
5505 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT:
5506 /* All RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads become live just after the
5507 instruction is executed. */
5508 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
5509 break;
5510 /* The first RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reload conflicts with
5511 the RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reloads, so assign it the same time
5512 value. */
5513 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
5514 if (type == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS && reloadnum == i + 1
5515 && ignore_address_reloads
5516 && ! rld[reloadnum].out)
5517 continue;
5518 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4 + rld[i].opnum;
5519 break;
5520 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
5521 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 5 + rld[i].opnum;
5522 break;
5523 case RELOAD_OTHER:
5524 /* If there is no conflict in the input part, handle this
5525 like an output reload. */
5526 if (! rld[i].in || rtx_equal_p (other_input, value))
5528 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 4;
5529 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
5530 if (earlyclobber_operand_p (rld[i].out))
5531 time2 = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3;
5533 break;
5535 time2 = 1;
5536 /* RELOAD_OTHER might be live beyond instruction execution,
5537 but this is not obvious when we set time2 = 1. So check
5538 here if there might be a problem with the new reload
5539 clobbering the register used by the RELOAD_OTHER. */
5540 if (out)
5541 return 0;
5542 break;
5543 default:
5544 return 0;
5546 if ((time1 >= time2
5547 && (! rld[i].in || rld[i].out
5548 || ! rtx_equal_p (other_input, value)))
5549 || (out && rld[reloadnum].out_reg
5550 && time2 >= MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS * 4 + 3))
5551 return 0;
5556 /* Earlyclobbered outputs must conflict with inputs. */
5557 if (check_earlyclobber && out && earlyclobber_operand_p (out))
5558 return 0;
5560 return 1;
5563 /* Return 1 if the value in reload reg REGNO, as used by a reload
5564 needed for the part of the insn specified by OPNUM and TYPE,
5565 may be used to load VALUE into it.
5567 MODE is the mode in which the register is used, this is needed to
5568 determine how many hard regs to test.
5570 Other read-only reloads with the same value do not conflict
5571 unless OUT is nonzero and these other reloads have to live while
5572 output reloads live.
5573 If OUT is CONST0_RTX, this is a special case: it means that the
5574 test should not be for using register REGNO as reload register, but
5575 for copying from register REGNO into the reload register.
5577 RELOADNUM is the number of the reload we want to load this value for;
5578 a reload does not conflict with itself.
5580 When IGNORE_ADDRESS_RELOADS is set, we can not have conflicts with
5581 reloads that load an address for the very reload we are considering.
5583 The caller has to make sure that there is no conflict with the return
5584 register. */
5586 static int
5587 free_for_value_p (int regno, enum machine_mode mode, int opnum,
5588 enum reload_type type, rtx value, rtx out, int reloadnum,
5589 int ignore_address_reloads)
5591 int nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
5592 while (nregs-- > 0)
5593 if (! reload_reg_free_for_value_p (regno, regno + nregs, opnum, type,
5594 value, out, reloadnum,
5595 ignore_address_reloads))
5596 return 0;
5597 return 1;
5600 /* Return nonzero if the rtx X is invariant over the current function. */
5601 /* ??? Actually, the places where we use this expect exactly what is
5602 tested here, and not everything that is function invariant. In
5603 particular, the frame pointer and arg pointer are special cased;
5604 pic_offset_table_rtx is not, and we must not spill these things to
5605 memory. */
5608 function_invariant_p (const_rtx x)
5610 if (CONSTANT_P (x))
5611 return 1;
5612 if (x == frame_pointer_rtx || x == arg_pointer_rtx)
5613 return 1;
5614 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
5615 && (XEXP (x, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx || XEXP (x, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx)
5616 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
5617 return 1;
5618 return 0;
5621 /* Determine whether the reload reg X overlaps any rtx'es used for
5622 overriding inheritance. Return nonzero if so. */
5624 static int
5625 conflicts_with_override (rtx x)
5627 int i;
5628 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5629 if (reload_override_in[i]
5630 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, reload_override_in[i]))
5631 return 1;
5632 return 0;
5635 /* Give an error message saying we failed to find a reload for INSN,
5636 and clear out reload R. */
5637 static void
5638 failed_reload (rtx insn, int r)
5640 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
5641 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
5642 fatal_insn ("could not find a spill register", insn);
5644 /* It's the user's fault; the operand's mode and constraint
5645 don't match. Disable this reload so we don't crash in final. */
5646 error_for_asm (insn,
5647 "%<asm%> operand constraint incompatible with operand size");
5648 rld[r].in = 0;
5649 rld[r].out = 0;
5650 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
5651 rld[r].optional = 1;
5652 rld[r].secondary_p = 1;
5655 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to allocate
5656 for reload R. If it's valid, get an rtx for it. Return nonzero if
5657 successful. */
5658 static int
5659 set_reload_reg (int i, int r)
5661 int regno;
5662 rtx reg = spill_reg_rtx[i];
5664 if (reg == 0 || GET_MODE (reg) != rld[r].mode)
5665 spill_reg_rtx[i] = reg
5666 = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, spill_regs[i]);
5668 regno = true_regnum (reg);
5670 /* Detect when the reload reg can't hold the reload mode.
5671 This used to be one `if', but Sequent compiler can't handle that. */
5672 if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
5674 enum machine_mode test_mode = VOIDmode;
5675 if (rld[r].in)
5676 test_mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
5677 /* If rld[r].in has VOIDmode, it means we will load it
5678 in whatever mode the reload reg has: to wit, rld[r].mode.
5679 We have already tested that for validity. */
5680 /* Aside from that, we need to test that the expressions
5681 to reload from or into have modes which are valid for this
5682 reload register. Otherwise the reload insns would be invalid. */
5683 if (! (rld[r].in != 0 && test_mode != VOIDmode
5684 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, test_mode)))
5685 if (! (rld[r].out != 0
5686 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, GET_MODE (rld[r].out))))
5688 /* The reg is OK. */
5689 last_spill_reg = i;
5691 /* Mark as in use for this insn the reload regs we use
5692 for this. */
5693 mark_reload_reg_in_use (spill_regs[i], rld[r].opnum,
5694 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].mode);
5696 rld[r].reg_rtx = reg;
5697 reload_spill_index[r] = spill_regs[i];
5698 return 1;
5701 return 0;
5704 /* Find a spill register to use as a reload register for reload R.
5705 LAST_RELOAD is nonzero if this is the last reload for the insn being
5706 processed.
5708 Set rld[R].reg_rtx to the register allocated.
5710 We return 1 if successful, or 0 if we couldn't find a spill reg and
5711 we didn't change anything. */
5713 static int
5714 allocate_reload_reg (struct insn_chain *chain ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int r,
5715 int last_reload)
5717 int i, pass, count;
5719 /* If we put this reload ahead, thinking it is a group,
5720 then insist on finding a group. Otherwise we can grab a
5721 reg that some other reload needs.
5722 (That can happen when we have a 68000 DATA_OR_FP_REG
5723 which is a group of data regs or one fp reg.)
5724 We need not be so restrictive if there are no more reloads
5725 for this insn.
5727 ??? Really it would be nicer to have smarter handling
5728 for that kind of reg class, where a problem like this is normal.
5729 Perhaps those classes should be avoided for reloading
5730 by use of more alternatives. */
5732 int force_group = rld[r].nregs > 1 && ! last_reload;
5734 /* If we want a single register and haven't yet found one,
5735 take any reg in the right class and not in use.
5736 If we want a consecutive group, here is where we look for it.
5738 We use two passes so we can first look for reload regs to
5739 reuse, which are already in use for other reloads in this insn,
5740 and only then use additional registers.
5741 I think that maximizing reuse is needed to make sure we don't
5742 run out of reload regs. Suppose we have three reloads, and
5743 reloads A and B can share regs. These need two regs.
5744 Suppose A and B are given different regs.
5745 That leaves none for C. */
5746 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; pass++)
5748 /* I is the index in spill_regs.
5749 We advance it round-robin between insns to use all spill regs
5750 equally, so that inherited reloads have a chance
5751 of leapfrogging each other. */
5753 i = last_spill_reg;
5755 for (count = 0; count < n_spills; count++)
5757 int rclass = (int) rld[r].rclass;
5758 int regnum;
5760 i++;
5761 if (i >= n_spills)
5762 i -= n_spills;
5763 regnum = spill_regs[i];
5765 if ((reload_reg_free_p (regnum, rld[r].opnum,
5766 rld[r].when_needed)
5767 || (rld[r].in
5768 /* We check reload_reg_used to make sure we
5769 don't clobber the return register. */
5770 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used, regnum)
5771 && free_for_value_p (regnum, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
5772 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
5773 rld[r].out, r, 1)))
5774 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[rclass], regnum)
5775 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regnum, rld[r].mode)
5776 /* Look first for regs to share, then for unshared. But
5777 don't share regs used for inherited reloads; they are
5778 the ones we want to preserve. */
5779 && (pass
5780 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
5781 regnum)
5782 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
5783 regnum))))
5785 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[regnum][rld[r].mode];
5786 /* Avoid the problem where spilling a GENERAL_OR_FP_REG
5787 (on 68000) got us two FP regs. If NR is 1,
5788 we would reject both of them. */
5789 if (force_group)
5790 nr = rld[r].nregs;
5791 /* If we need only one reg, we have already won. */
5792 if (nr == 1)
5794 /* But reject a single reg if we demand a group. */
5795 if (force_group)
5796 continue;
5797 break;
5799 /* Otherwise check that as many consecutive regs as we need
5800 are available here. */
5801 while (nr > 1)
5803 int regno = regnum + nr - 1;
5804 if (!(TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[rclass], regno)
5805 && spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0
5806 && reload_reg_free_p (regno, rld[r].opnum,
5807 rld[r].when_needed)))
5808 break;
5809 nr--;
5811 if (nr == 1)
5812 break;
5816 /* If we found something on pass 1, omit pass 2. */
5817 if (count < n_spills)
5818 break;
5821 /* We should have found a spill register by now. */
5822 if (count >= n_spills)
5823 return 0;
5825 /* I is the index in SPILL_REG_RTX of the reload register we are to
5826 allocate. Get an rtx for it and find its register number. */
5828 return set_reload_reg (i, r);
5831 /* Initialize all the tables needed to allocate reload registers.
5832 CHAIN is the insn currently being processed; SAVE_RELOAD_REG_RTX
5833 is the array we use to restore the reg_rtx field for every reload. */
5835 static void
5836 choose_reload_regs_init (struct insn_chain *chain, rtx *save_reload_reg_rtx)
5838 int i;
5840 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5841 rld[i].reg_rtx = save_reload_reg_rtx[i];
5843 memset (reload_inherited, 0, MAX_RELOADS);
5844 memset (reload_inheritance_insn, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
5845 memset (reload_override_in, 0, MAX_RELOADS * sizeof (rtx));
5847 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used);
5848 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_at_all);
5849 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr);
5850 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_op_addr_reload);
5851 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_insn);
5852 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_other_addr);
5854 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn);
5856 HARD_REG_SET tmp;
5857 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->live_throughout);
5858 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
5859 REG_SET_TO_HARD_REG_SET (tmp, &chain->dead_or_set);
5860 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_used_in_insn, tmp);
5861 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->live_throughout);
5862 compute_use_by_pseudos (&reg_used_in_insn, &chain->dead_or_set);
5865 for (i = 0; i < reload_n_operands; i++)
5867 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output[i]);
5868 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input[i]);
5869 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_input_addr[i]);
5870 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_inpaddr_addr[i]);
5871 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_output_addr[i]);
5872 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_in_outaddr_addr[i]);
5875 COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_unavailable, chain->used_spill_regs);
5877 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reload_reg_used_for_inherit);
5879 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
5880 /* If we have already decided to use a certain register,
5881 don't use it in another way. */
5882 if (rld[i].reg_rtx)
5883 mark_reload_reg_in_use (REGNO (rld[i].reg_rtx), rld[i].opnum,
5884 rld[i].when_needed, rld[i].mode);
5887 /* Assign hard reg targets for the pseudo-registers we must reload
5888 into hard regs for this insn.
5889 Also output the instructions to copy them in and out of the hard regs.
5891 For machines with register classes, we are responsible for
5892 finding a reload reg in the proper class. */
5894 static void
5895 choose_reload_regs (struct insn_chain *chain)
5897 rtx insn = chain->insn;
5898 int i, j;
5899 unsigned int max_group_size = 1;
5900 enum reg_class group_class = NO_REGS;
5901 int pass, win, inheritance;
5903 rtx save_reload_reg_rtx[MAX_RELOADS];
5905 /* In order to be certain of getting the registers we need,
5906 we must sort the reloads into order of increasing register class.
5907 Then our grabbing of reload registers will parallel the process
5908 that provided the reload registers.
5910 Also note whether any of the reloads wants a consecutive group of regs.
5911 If so, record the maximum size of the group desired and what
5912 register class contains all the groups needed by this insn. */
5914 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5916 reload_order[j] = j;
5917 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != NULL_RTX)
5919 gcc_assert (REG_P (rld[j].reg_rtx)
5920 && HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[j].reg_rtx));
5921 reload_spill_index[j] = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx);
5923 else
5924 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
5926 if (rld[j].nregs > 1)
5928 max_group_size = MAX (rld[j].nregs, max_group_size);
5929 group_class
5930 = reg_class_superunion[(int) rld[j].rclass][(int) group_class];
5933 save_reload_reg_rtx[j] = rld[j].reg_rtx;
5936 if (n_reloads > 1)
5937 qsort (reload_order, n_reloads, sizeof (short), reload_reg_class_lower);
5939 /* If -O, try first with inheritance, then turning it off.
5940 If not -O, don't do inheritance.
5941 Using inheritance when not optimizing leads to paradoxes
5942 with fp on the 68k: fp numbers (not NaNs) fail to be equal to themselves
5943 because one side of the comparison might be inherited. */
5944 win = 0;
5945 for (inheritance = optimize > 0; inheritance >= 0; inheritance--)
5947 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
5949 /* Process the reloads in order of preference just found.
5950 Beyond this point, subregs can be found in reload_reg_rtx.
5952 This used to look for an existing reloaded home for all of the
5953 reloads, and only then perform any new reloads. But that could lose
5954 if the reloads were done out of reg-class order because a later
5955 reload with a looser constraint might have an old home in a register
5956 needed by an earlier reload with a tighter constraint.
5958 To solve this, we make two passes over the reloads, in the order
5959 described above. In the first pass we try to inherit a reload
5960 from a previous insn. If there is a later reload that needs a
5961 class that is a proper subset of the class being processed, we must
5962 also allocate a spill register during the first pass.
5964 Then make a second pass over the reloads to allocate any reloads
5965 that haven't been given registers yet. */
5967 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
5969 int r = reload_order[j];
5970 rtx search_equiv = NULL_RTX;
5972 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
5973 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0
5974 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
5975 continue;
5977 /* If find_reloads chose to use reload_in or reload_out as a reload
5978 register, we don't need to chose one. Otherwise, try even if it
5979 found one since we might save an insn if we find the value lying
5980 around.
5981 Try also when reload_in is a pseudo without a hard reg. */
5982 if (rld[r].in != 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0
5983 && (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].in, rld[r].reg_rtx)
5984 || (rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)
5985 && !MEM_P (rld[r].in)
5986 && true_regnum (rld[r].in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
5987 continue;
5989 #if 0 /* No longer needed for correct operation.
5990 It might give better code, or might not; worth an experiment? */
5991 /* If this is an optional reload, we can't inherit from earlier insns
5992 until we are sure that any non-optional reloads have been allocated.
5993 The following code takes advantage of the fact that optional reloads
5994 are at the end of reload_order. */
5995 if (rld[r].optional != 0)
5996 for (i = 0; i < j; i++)
5997 if ((rld[reload_order[i]].out != 0
5998 || rld[reload_order[i]].in != 0
5999 || rld[reload_order[i]].secondary_p)
6000 && ! rld[reload_order[i]].optional
6001 && rld[reload_order[i]].reg_rtx == 0)
6002 allocate_reload_reg (chain, reload_order[i], 0);
6003 #endif
6005 /* First see if this pseudo is already available as reloaded
6006 for a previous insn. We cannot try to inherit for reloads
6007 that are smaller than the maximum number of registers needed
6008 for groups unless the register we would allocate cannot be used
6009 for the groups.
6011 We could check here to see if this is a secondary reload for
6012 an object that is already in a register of the desired class.
6013 This would avoid the need for the secondary reload register.
6014 But this is complex because we can't easily determine what
6015 objects might want to be loaded via this reload. So let a
6016 register be allocated here. In `emit_reload_insns' we suppress
6017 one of the loads in the case described above. */
6019 if (inheritance)
6021 int byte = 0;
6022 int regno = -1;
6023 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
6025 if (rld[r].in == 0)
6027 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in))
6029 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in);
6030 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in);
6032 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg))
6034 regno = REGNO (rld[r].in_reg);
6035 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
6037 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg) == SUBREG
6038 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg)))
6040 regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in_reg));
6041 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6042 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in_reg);
6043 else
6044 byte = SUBREG_BYTE (rld[r].in_reg);
6045 mode = GET_MODE (rld[r].in_reg);
6047 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
6048 else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (rld[r].in_reg)) == RTX_AUTOINC
6049 && REG_P (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0)))
6051 regno = REGNO (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
6052 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
6053 rld[r].out = rld[r].in;
6055 #endif
6056 #if 0
6057 /* This won't work, since REGNO can be a pseudo reg number.
6058 Also, it takes much more hair to keep track of all the things
6059 that can invalidate an inherited reload of part of a pseudoreg. */
6060 else if (GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == SUBREG
6061 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rld[r].in)))
6062 regno = subreg_regno (rld[r].in);
6063 #endif
6065 if (regno >= 0
6066 && reg_last_reload_reg[regno] != 0
6067 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
6068 /* Verify that the register it's in can be used in
6069 mode MODE. */
6070 && !REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[regno]),
6071 GET_MODE (reg_last_reload_reg[regno]),
6072 mode)
6073 #endif
6076 enum reg_class rclass = rld[r].rclass, last_class;
6077 rtx last_reg = reg_last_reload_reg[regno];
6078 enum machine_mode need_mode;
6080 i = REGNO (last_reg);
6081 i += subreg_regno_offset (i, GET_MODE (last_reg), byte, mode);
6082 last_class = REGNO_REG_CLASS (i);
6084 if (byte == 0)
6085 need_mode = mode;
6086 else
6087 need_mode
6088 = smallest_mode_for_size
6089 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) + byte * BITS_PER_UNIT,
6090 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT
6091 ? MODE_INT : GET_MODE_CLASS (mode));
6093 if ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (last_reg))
6094 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (need_mode))
6095 && reg_reloaded_contents[i] == regno
6096 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i)
6097 && HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (i, rld[r].mode)
6098 && (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rclass], i)
6099 /* Even if we can't use this register as a reload
6100 register, we might use it for reload_override_in,
6101 if copying it to the desired class is cheap
6102 enough. */
6103 || ((REGISTER_MOVE_COST (mode, last_class, rclass)
6104 < MEMORY_MOVE_COST (mode, rclass, 1))
6105 && (secondary_reload_class (1, rclass, mode,
6106 last_reg)
6107 == NO_REGS)
6108 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
6109 && ! SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (last_class, rclass,
6110 mode)
6111 #endif
6114 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
6115 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) group_class],
6117 && free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode, rld[r].opnum,
6118 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6119 const0_rtx, r, 1))
6121 /* If a group is needed, verify that all the subsequent
6122 registers still have their values intact. */
6123 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][rld[r].mode];
6124 int k;
6126 for (k = 1; k < nr; k++)
6127 if (reg_reloaded_contents[i + k] != regno
6128 || ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k))
6129 break;
6131 if (k == nr)
6133 int i1;
6134 int bad_for_class;
6136 last_reg = (GET_MODE (last_reg) == mode
6137 ? last_reg : gen_rtx_REG (mode, i));
6139 bad_for_class = 0;
6140 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6141 bad_for_class |= ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].rclass],
6142 i+k);
6144 /* We found a register that contains the
6145 value we need. If this register is the
6146 same as an `earlyclobber' operand of the
6147 current insn, just mark it as a place to
6148 reload from since we can't use it as the
6149 reload register itself. */
6151 for (i1 = 0; i1 < n_earlyclobbers; i1++)
6152 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p
6153 (reg_last_reload_reg[regno],
6154 reload_earlyclobbers[i1]))
6155 break;
6157 if (i1 != n_earlyclobbers
6158 || ! (free_for_value_p (i, rld[r].mode,
6159 rld[r].opnum,
6160 rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6161 rld[r].out, r, 1))
6162 /* Don't use it if we'd clobber a pseudo reg. */
6163 || (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_used_in_insn, i)
6164 && rld[r].out
6165 && ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, i))
6166 /* Don't clobber the frame pointer. */
6167 || (i == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
6168 && frame_pointer_needed
6169 && rld[r].out)
6170 /* Don't really use the inherited spill reg
6171 if we need it wider than we've got it. */
6172 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (rld[r].mode)
6173 > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
6174 || bad_for_class
6176 /* If find_reloads chose reload_out as reload
6177 register, stay with it - that leaves the
6178 inherited register for subsequent reloads. */
6179 || (rld[r].out && rld[r].reg_rtx
6180 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, rld[r].reg_rtx)))
6182 if (! rld[r].optional)
6184 reload_override_in[r] = last_reg;
6185 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
6186 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
6189 else
6191 int k;
6192 /* We can use this as a reload reg. */
6193 /* Mark the register as in use for this part of
6194 the insn. */
6195 mark_reload_reg_in_use (i,
6196 rld[r].opnum,
6197 rld[r].when_needed,
6198 rld[r].mode);
6199 rld[r].reg_rtx = last_reg;
6200 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
6201 reload_inheritance_insn[r]
6202 = reg_reloaded_insn[i];
6203 reload_spill_index[r] = i;
6204 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6205 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
6206 i + k);
6213 /* Here's another way to see if the value is already lying around. */
6214 if (inheritance
6215 && rld[r].in != 0
6216 && ! reload_inherited[r]
6217 && rld[r].out == 0
6218 && (CONSTANT_P (rld[r].in)
6219 || GET_CODE (rld[r].in) == PLUS
6220 || REG_P (rld[r].in)
6221 || MEM_P (rld[r].in))
6222 && (rld[r].nregs == max_group_size
6223 || ! reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].rclass, group_class)))
6224 search_equiv = rld[r].in;
6225 /* If this is an output reload from a simple move insn, look
6226 if an equivalence for the input is available. */
6227 else if (inheritance && rld[r].in == 0 && rld[r].out != 0)
6229 rtx set = single_set (insn);
6231 if (set
6232 && rtx_equal_p (rld[r].out, SET_DEST (set))
6233 && CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (set)))
6234 search_equiv = SET_SRC (set);
6237 if (search_equiv)
6239 rtx equiv
6240 = find_equiv_reg (search_equiv, insn, rld[r].rclass,
6241 -1, NULL, 0, rld[r].mode);
6242 int regno = 0;
6244 if (equiv != 0)
6246 if (REG_P (equiv))
6247 regno = REGNO (equiv);
6248 else
6250 /* This must be a SUBREG of a hard register.
6251 Make a new REG since this might be used in an
6252 address and not all machines support SUBREGs
6253 there. */
6254 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (equiv) == SUBREG);
6255 regno = subreg_regno (equiv);
6256 equiv = gen_rtx_REG (rld[r].mode, regno);
6257 /* If we choose EQUIV as the reload register, but the
6258 loop below decides to cancel the inheritance, we'll
6259 end up reloading EQUIV in rld[r].mode, not the mode
6260 it had originally. That isn't safe when EQUIV isn't
6261 available as a spill register since its value might
6262 still be live at this point. */
6263 for (i = regno; i < regno + (int) rld[r].nregs; i++)
6264 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_unavailable, i))
6265 equiv = 0;
6269 /* If we found a spill reg, reject it unless it is free
6270 and of the desired class. */
6271 if (equiv != 0)
6273 int regs_used = 0;
6274 int bad_for_class = 0;
6275 int max_regno = regno + rld[r].nregs;
6277 for (i = regno; i < max_regno; i++)
6279 regs_used |= TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_at_all,
6281 bad_for_class |= ! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) rld[r].rclass],
6285 if ((regs_used
6286 && ! free_for_value_p (regno, rld[r].mode,
6287 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
6288 rld[r].in, rld[r].out, r, 1))
6289 || bad_for_class)
6290 equiv = 0;
6293 if (equiv != 0 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, rld[r].mode))
6294 equiv = 0;
6296 /* We found a register that contains the value we need.
6297 If this register is the same as an `earlyclobber' operand
6298 of the current insn, just mark it as a place to reload from
6299 since we can't use it as the reload register itself. */
6301 if (equiv != 0)
6302 for (i = 0; i < n_earlyclobbers; i++)
6303 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (equiv,
6304 reload_earlyclobbers[i]))
6306 if (! rld[r].optional)
6307 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
6308 equiv = 0;
6309 break;
6312 /* If the equiv register we have found is explicitly clobbered
6313 in the current insn, it depends on the reload type if we
6314 can use it, use it for reload_override_in, or not at all.
6315 In particular, we then can't use EQUIV for a
6316 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload. */
6318 if (equiv != 0)
6320 if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 2))
6321 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
6323 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6324 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6325 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6326 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6327 break;
6328 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6329 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6330 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6331 if (! rld[r].optional)
6332 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
6333 /* Fall through. */
6334 default:
6335 equiv = 0;
6336 break;
6338 else if (regno_clobbered_p (regno, insn, rld[r].mode, 1))
6339 switch (rld[r].when_needed)
6341 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6342 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6343 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6344 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6345 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6346 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6347 break;
6348 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6349 if (! rld[r].optional)
6350 reload_override_in[r] = equiv;
6351 /* Fall through. */
6352 default:
6353 equiv = 0;
6354 break;
6358 /* If we found an equivalent reg, say no code need be generated
6359 to load it, and use it as our reload reg. */
6360 if (equiv != 0
6361 && (regno != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
6362 || !frame_pointer_needed))
6364 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[regno][rld[r].mode];
6365 int k;
6366 rld[r].reg_rtx = equiv;
6367 reload_spill_index[r] = regno;
6368 reload_inherited[r] = 1;
6370 /* If reg_reloaded_valid is not set for this register,
6371 there might be a stale spill_reg_store lying around.
6372 We must clear it, since otherwise emit_reload_insns
6373 might delete the store. */
6374 if (! TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno))
6375 spill_reg_store[regno] = NULL_RTX;
6376 /* If any of the hard registers in EQUIV are spill
6377 registers, mark them as in use for this insn. */
6378 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
6380 i = spill_reg_order[regno + k];
6381 if (i >= 0)
6383 mark_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum,
6384 rld[r].when_needed,
6385 rld[r].mode);
6386 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reload_reg_used_for_inherit,
6387 regno + k);
6393 /* If we found a register to use already, or if this is an optional
6394 reload, we are done. */
6395 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional != 0)
6396 continue;
6398 #if 0
6399 /* No longer needed for correct operation. Might or might
6400 not give better code on the average. Want to experiment? */
6402 /* See if there is a later reload that has a class different from our
6403 class that intersects our class or that requires less register
6404 than our reload. If so, we must allocate a register to this
6405 reload now, since that reload might inherit a previous reload
6406 and take the only available register in our class. Don't do this
6407 for optional reloads since they will force all previous reloads
6408 to be allocated. Also don't do this for reloads that have been
6409 turned off. */
6411 for (i = j + 1; i < n_reloads; i++)
6413 int s = reload_order[i];
6415 if ((rld[s].in == 0 && rld[s].out == 0
6416 && ! rld[s].secondary_p)
6417 || rld[s].optional)
6418 continue;
6420 if ((rld[s].rclass != rld[r].rclass
6421 && reg_classes_intersect_p (rld[r].rclass,
6422 rld[s].rclass))
6423 || rld[s].nregs < rld[r].nregs)
6424 break;
6427 if (i == n_reloads)
6428 continue;
6430 allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1);
6431 #endif
6434 /* Now allocate reload registers for anything non-optional that
6435 didn't get one yet. */
6436 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6438 int r = reload_order[j];
6440 /* Ignore reloads that got marked inoperative. */
6441 if (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].in == 0 && ! rld[r].secondary_p)
6442 continue;
6444 /* Skip reloads that already have a register allocated or are
6445 optional. */
6446 if (rld[r].reg_rtx != 0 || rld[r].optional)
6447 continue;
6449 if (! allocate_reload_reg (chain, r, j == n_reloads - 1))
6450 break;
6453 /* If that loop got all the way, we have won. */
6454 if (j == n_reloads)
6456 win = 1;
6457 break;
6460 /* Loop around and try without any inheritance. */
6463 if (! win)
6465 /* First undo everything done by the failed attempt
6466 to allocate with inheritance. */
6467 choose_reload_regs_init (chain, save_reload_reg_rtx);
6469 /* Some sanity tests to verify that the reloads found in the first
6470 pass are identical to the ones we have now. */
6471 gcc_assert (chain->n_reloads == n_reloads);
6473 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6475 if (chain->rld[i].regno < 0 || chain->rld[i].reg_rtx != 0)
6476 continue;
6477 gcc_assert (chain->rld[i].when_needed == rld[i].when_needed);
6478 for (j = 0; j < n_spills; j++)
6479 if (spill_regs[j] == chain->rld[i].regno)
6480 if (! set_reload_reg (j, i))
6481 failed_reload (chain->insn, i);
6485 /* If we thought we could inherit a reload, because it seemed that
6486 nothing else wanted the same reload register earlier in the insn,
6487 verify that assumption, now that all reloads have been assigned.
6488 Likewise for reloads where reload_override_in has been set. */
6490 /* If doing expensive optimizations, do one preliminary pass that doesn't
6491 cancel any inheritance, but removes reloads that have been needed only
6492 for reloads that we know can be inherited. */
6493 for (pass = flag_expensive_optimizations; pass >= 0; pass--)
6495 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6497 int r = reload_order[j];
6498 rtx check_reg;
6499 if (reload_inherited[r] && rld[r].reg_rtx)
6500 check_reg = rld[r].reg_rtx;
6501 else if (reload_override_in[r]
6502 && (REG_P (reload_override_in[r])
6503 || GET_CODE (reload_override_in[r]) == SUBREG))
6504 check_reg = reload_override_in[r];
6505 else
6506 continue;
6507 if (! free_for_value_p (true_regnum (check_reg), rld[r].mode,
6508 rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed, rld[r].in,
6509 (reload_inherited[r]
6510 ? rld[r].out : const0_rtx),
6511 r, 1))
6513 if (pass)
6514 continue;
6515 reload_inherited[r] = 0;
6516 reload_override_in[r] = 0;
6518 /* If we can inherit a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, or can use a
6519 reload_override_in, then we do not need its related
6520 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS / RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads;
6521 likewise for other reload types.
6522 We handle this by removing a reload when its only replacement
6523 is mentioned in reload_in of the reload we are going to inherit.
6524 A special case are auto_inc expressions; even if the input is
6525 inherited, we still need the address for the output. We can
6526 recognize them because they have RELOAD_OUT set to RELOAD_IN.
6527 If we succeeded removing some reload and we are doing a preliminary
6528 pass just to remove such reloads, make another pass, since the
6529 removal of one reload might allow us to inherit another one. */
6530 else if (rld[r].in
6531 && rld[r].out != rld[r].in
6532 && remove_address_replacements (rld[r].in) && pass)
6533 pass = 2;
6537 /* Now that reload_override_in is known valid,
6538 actually override reload_in. */
6539 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6540 if (reload_override_in[j])
6541 rld[j].in = reload_override_in[j];
6543 /* If this reload won't be done because it has been canceled or is
6544 optional and not inherited, clear reload_reg_rtx so other
6545 routines (such as subst_reloads) don't get confused. */
6546 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6547 if (rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
6548 && ((rld[j].optional && ! reload_inherited[j])
6549 || (rld[j].in == 0 && rld[j].out == 0
6550 && ! rld[j].secondary_p)))
6552 int regno = true_regnum (rld[j].reg_rtx);
6554 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
6555 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[j].opnum,
6556 rld[j].when_needed, rld[j].mode);
6557 rld[j].reg_rtx = 0;
6558 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
6561 /* Record which pseudos and which spill regs have output reloads. */
6562 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6564 int r = reload_order[j];
6566 i = reload_spill_index[r];
6568 /* I is nonneg if this reload uses a register.
6569 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
6570 that we opted to ignore. */
6571 if (rld[r].out_reg != 0 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg)
6572 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
6574 int nregno = REGNO (rld[r].out_reg);
6575 int nr = 1;
6577 if (nregno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6578 nr = hard_regno_nregs[nregno][rld[r].mode];
6580 while (--nr >= 0)
6581 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
6582 nregno + nr);
6584 if (i >= 0)
6586 nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][rld[r].mode];
6587 while (--nr >= 0)
6588 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, i + nr);
6591 gcc_assert (rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER
6592 || rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT
6593 || rld[r].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INSN);
6598 /* Deallocate the reload register for reload R. This is called from
6599 remove_address_replacements. */
6601 void
6602 deallocate_reload_reg (int r)
6604 int regno;
6606 if (! rld[r].reg_rtx)
6607 return;
6608 regno = true_regnum (rld[r].reg_rtx);
6609 rld[r].reg_rtx = 0;
6610 if (spill_reg_order[regno] >= 0)
6611 clear_reload_reg_in_use (regno, rld[r].opnum, rld[r].when_needed,
6612 rld[r].mode);
6613 reload_spill_index[r] = -1;
6616 /* If SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES is nonzero, we may not have merged two
6617 reloads of the same item for fear that we might not have enough reload
6618 registers. However, normally they will get the same reload register
6619 and hence actually need not be loaded twice.
6621 Here we check for the most common case of this phenomenon: when we have
6622 a number of reloads for the same object, each of which were allocated
6623 the same reload_reg_rtx, that reload_reg_rtx is not used for any other
6624 reload, and is not modified in the insn itself. If we find such,
6625 merge all the reloads and set the resulting reload to RELOAD_OTHER.
6626 This will not increase the number of spill registers needed and will
6627 prevent redundant code. */
6629 static void
6630 merge_assigned_reloads (rtx insn)
6632 int i, j;
6634 /* Scan all the reloads looking for ones that only load values and
6635 are not already RELOAD_OTHER and ones whose reload_reg_rtx are
6636 assigned and not modified by INSN. */
6638 for (i = 0; i < n_reloads; i++)
6640 int conflicting_input = 0;
6641 int max_input_address_opnum = -1;
6642 int min_conflicting_input_opnum = MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS;
6644 if (rld[i].in == 0 || rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER
6645 || rld[i].out != 0 || rld[i].reg_rtx == 0
6646 || reg_set_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, insn))
6647 continue;
6649 /* Look at all other reloads. Ensure that the only use of this
6650 reload_reg_rtx is in a reload that just loads the same value
6651 as we do. Note that any secondary reloads must be of the identical
6652 class since the values, modes, and result registers are the
6653 same, so we need not do anything with any secondary reloads. */
6655 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6657 if (i == j || rld[j].reg_rtx == 0
6658 || ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (rld[j].reg_rtx,
6659 rld[i].reg_rtx))
6660 continue;
6662 if (rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6663 && rld[j].opnum > max_input_address_opnum)
6664 max_input_address_opnum = rld[j].opnum;
6666 /* If the reload regs aren't exactly the same (e.g, different modes)
6667 or if the values are different, we can't merge this reload.
6668 But if it is an input reload, we might still merge
6669 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS and RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads. */
6671 if (! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, rld[j].reg_rtx)
6672 || rld[j].out != 0 || rld[j].in == 0
6673 || ! rtx_equal_p (rld[i].in, rld[j].in))
6675 if (rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT
6676 || ((rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6677 || rld[i].opnum > rld[j].opnum)
6678 && rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
6679 break;
6680 conflicting_input = 1;
6681 if (min_conflicting_input_opnum > rld[j].opnum)
6682 min_conflicting_input_opnum = rld[j].opnum;
6686 /* If all is OK, merge the reloads. Only set this to RELOAD_OTHER if
6687 we, in fact, found any matching reloads. */
6689 if (j == n_reloads
6690 && max_input_address_opnum <= min_conflicting_input_opnum)
6692 gcc_assert (rld[i].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT);
6694 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6695 if (i != j && rld[j].reg_rtx != 0
6696 && rtx_equal_p (rld[i].reg_rtx, rld[j].reg_rtx)
6697 && (! conflicting_input
6698 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6699 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS))
6701 rld[i].when_needed = RELOAD_OTHER;
6702 rld[j].in = 0;
6703 reload_spill_index[j] = -1;
6704 transfer_replacements (i, j);
6707 /* If this is now RELOAD_OTHER, look for any reloads that
6708 load parts of this operand and set them to
6709 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS if they were for inputs,
6710 RELOAD_OTHER for outputs. Note that this test is
6711 equivalent to looking for reloads for this operand
6712 number.
6714 We must take special care with RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS;
6715 it may share registers with a RELOAD_FOR_INPUT, so we can
6716 not change it to RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS. We should
6717 never need to, since we do not modify RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT.
6719 It is possible that the RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
6720 instruction is assigned the same register as the earlier
6721 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS instruction. Merging these two
6722 instructions will cause the RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
6723 instruction to be deleted later on. */
6725 if (rld[i].when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
6726 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
6727 if (rld[j].in != 0
6728 && rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_OTHER
6729 && rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS
6730 && rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS
6731 && rld[j].when_needed != RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS
6732 && (! conflicting_input
6733 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6734 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
6735 && reg_overlap_mentioned_for_reload_p (rld[j].in,
6736 rld[i].in))
6738 int k;
6740 rld[j].when_needed
6741 = ((rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS
6742 || rld[j].when_needed == RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS)
6743 ? RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS : RELOAD_OTHER);
6745 /* Check to see if we accidentally converted two
6746 reloads that use the same reload register with
6747 different inputs to the same type. If so, the
6748 resulting code won't work. */
6749 if (rld[j].reg_rtx)
6750 for (k = 0; k < j; k++)
6751 gcc_assert (rld[k].in == 0 || rld[k].reg_rtx == 0
6752 || rld[k].when_needed != rld[j].when_needed
6753 || !rtx_equal_p (rld[k].reg_rtx,
6754 rld[j].reg_rtx)
6755 || rtx_equal_p (rld[k].in,
6756 rld[j].in));
6762 /* These arrays are filled by emit_reload_insns and its subroutines. */
6763 static rtx input_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6764 static rtx other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
6765 static rtx other_input_reload_insns = 0;
6766 static rtx input_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6767 static rtx inpaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6768 static rtx output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6769 static rtx output_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6770 static rtx outaddr_address_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6771 static rtx operand_reload_insns = 0;
6772 static rtx other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
6773 static rtx other_output_reload_insns[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
6775 /* Values to be put in spill_reg_store are put here first. */
6776 static rtx new_spill_reg_store[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
6777 static HARD_REG_SET reg_reloaded_died;
6779 /* Check if *RELOAD_REG is suitable as an intermediate or scratch register
6780 of class NEW_CLASS with mode NEW_MODE. Or alternatively, if alt_reload_reg
6781 is nonzero, if that is suitable. On success, change *RELOAD_REG to the
6782 adjusted register, and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
6783 static bool
6784 reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (rtx *reload_reg, rtx alt_reload_reg,
6785 enum reg_class new_class,
6786 enum machine_mode new_mode)
6789 rtx reg;
6791 for (reg = *reload_reg; reg; reg = alt_reload_reg, alt_reload_reg = 0)
6793 unsigned regno = REGNO (reg);
6795 if (!TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) new_class], regno))
6796 continue;
6797 if (GET_MODE (reg) != new_mode)
6799 if (!HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, new_mode))
6800 continue;
6801 if (hard_regno_nregs[regno][new_mode]
6802 > hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (reg)])
6803 continue;
6804 reg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg, new_mode);
6806 *reload_reg = reg;
6807 return true;
6809 return false;
6812 /* Check if *RELOAD_REG is suitable as a scratch register for the reload
6813 pattern with insn_code ICODE, or alternatively, if alt_reload_reg is
6814 nonzero, if that is suitable. On success, change *RELOAD_REG to the
6815 adjusted register, and return true. Otherwise, return false. */
6816 static bool
6817 reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (rtx *reload_reg, rtx alt_reload_reg,
6818 enum insn_code icode)
6821 enum reg_class new_class = scratch_reload_class (icode);
6822 enum machine_mode new_mode = insn_data[(int) icode].operand[2].mode;
6824 return reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (reload_reg, alt_reload_reg,
6825 new_class, new_mode);
6828 /* Generate insns to perform reload RL, which is for the insn in CHAIN and
6829 has the number J. OLD contains the value to be used as input. */
6831 static void
6832 emit_input_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl,
6833 rtx old, int j)
6835 rtx insn = chain->insn;
6836 rtx reloadreg;
6837 rtx oldequiv_reg = 0;
6838 rtx oldequiv = 0;
6839 int special = 0;
6840 enum machine_mode mode;
6841 rtx *where;
6843 /* delete_output_reload is only invoked properly if old contains
6844 the original pseudo register. Since this is replaced with a
6845 hard reg when RELOAD_OVERRIDE_IN is set, see if we can
6846 find the pseudo in RELOAD_IN_REG. */
6847 if (reload_override_in[j]
6848 && REG_P (rl->in_reg))
6850 oldequiv = old;
6851 old = rl->in_reg;
6853 if (oldequiv == 0)
6854 oldequiv = old;
6855 else if (REG_P (oldequiv))
6856 oldequiv_reg = oldequiv;
6857 else if (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
6858 oldequiv_reg = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
6860 reloadreg = reload_reg_rtx_for_input[j];
6861 mode = GET_MODE (reloadreg);
6863 /* If we are reloading from a register that was recently stored in
6864 with an output-reload, see if we can prove there was
6865 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
6867 if (optimize && REG_P (oldequiv)
6868 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6869 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
6870 && REG_P (old)
6871 && (dead_or_set_p (insn, spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
6872 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
6873 rl->out_reg)))
6874 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv), reloadreg);
6876 /* Encapsulate OLDEQUIV into the reload mode, then load RELOADREG from
6877 OLDEQUIV. */
6879 while (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG && GET_MODE (oldequiv) != mode)
6880 oldequiv = SUBREG_REG (oldequiv);
6881 if (GET_MODE (oldequiv) != VOIDmode
6882 && mode != GET_MODE (oldequiv))
6883 oldequiv = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, oldequiv);
6885 /* Switch to the right place to emit the reload insns. */
6886 switch (rl->when_needed)
6888 case RELOAD_OTHER:
6889 where = &other_input_reload_insns;
6890 break;
6891 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT:
6892 where = &input_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6893 break;
6894 case RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS:
6895 where = &input_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6896 break;
6897 case RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS:
6898 where = &inpaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6899 break;
6900 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS:
6901 where = &output_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6902 break;
6903 case RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS:
6904 where = &outaddr_address_reload_insns[rl->opnum];
6905 break;
6906 case RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS:
6907 where = &operand_reload_insns;
6908 break;
6909 case RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDR:
6910 where = &other_operand_reload_insns;
6911 break;
6912 case RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS:
6913 where = &other_input_address_reload_insns;
6914 break;
6915 default:
6916 gcc_unreachable ();
6919 push_to_sequence (*where);
6921 /* Auto-increment addresses must be reloaded in a special way. */
6922 if (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg)
6924 /* We are not going to bother supporting the case where a
6925 incremented register can't be copied directly from
6926 OLDEQUIV since this seems highly unlikely. */
6927 gcc_assert (rl->secondary_in_reload < 0);
6929 if (reload_inherited[j])
6930 oldequiv = reloadreg;
6932 old = XEXP (rl->in_reg, 0);
6934 if (optimize && REG_P (oldequiv)
6935 && REGNO (oldequiv) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6936 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (oldequiv)]
6937 && REG_P (old)
6938 && (dead_or_set_p (insn,
6939 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)])
6940 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (oldequiv)],
6941 old)))
6942 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (oldequiv), reloadreg);
6944 /* Prevent normal processing of this reload. */
6945 special = 1;
6946 /* Output a special code sequence for this case. */
6947 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (reloadreg)]
6948 = inc_for_reload (reloadreg, oldequiv, rl->out,
6949 rl->inc);
6952 /* If we are reloading a pseudo-register that was set by the previous
6953 insn, see if we can get rid of that pseudo-register entirely
6954 by redirecting the previous insn into our reload register. */
6956 else if (optimize && REG_P (old)
6957 && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
6958 && dead_or_set_p (insn, old)
6959 /* This is unsafe if some other reload
6960 uses the same reg first. */
6961 && ! conflicts_with_override (reloadreg)
6962 && free_for_value_p (REGNO (reloadreg), rl->mode, rl->opnum,
6963 rl->when_needed, old, rl->out, j, 0))
6965 rtx temp = PREV_INSN (insn);
6966 while (temp && NOTE_P (temp))
6967 temp = PREV_INSN (temp);
6968 if (temp
6969 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (temp)
6970 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (temp)) == SET
6971 && SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) == old
6972 /* Make sure we can access insn_operand_constraint. */
6973 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (temp)) < 0
6974 /* This is unsafe if operand occurs more than once in current
6975 insn. Perhaps some occurrences aren't reloaded. */
6976 && count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), old, 0) == 1)
6978 rtx old = SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp));
6979 /* Store into the reload register instead of the pseudo. */
6980 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = reloadreg;
6982 /* Verify that resulting insn is valid. */
6983 extract_insn (temp);
6984 if (constrain_operands (1))
6986 /* If the previous insn is an output reload, the source is
6987 a reload register, and its spill_reg_store entry will
6988 contain the previous destination. This is now
6989 invalid. */
6990 if (REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))
6991 && REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp))) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6993 spill_reg_store[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
6994 spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (temp)))] = 0;
6997 /* If these are the only uses of the pseudo reg,
6998 pretend for GDB it lives in the reload reg we used. */
6999 if (REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (old)) == 1
7000 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (old)) == 1)
7002 reg_renumber[REGNO (old)] = REGNO (reloadreg);
7003 if (flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p)
7004 /* Inform IRA about the change. */
7005 ira_mark_allocation_change (REGNO (old));
7006 alter_reg (REGNO (old), -1, false);
7008 special = 1;
7010 else
7012 SET_DEST (PATTERN (temp)) = old;
7017 /* We can't do that, so output an insn to load RELOADREG. */
7019 /* If we have a secondary reload, pick up the secondary register
7020 and icode, if any. If OLDEQUIV and OLD are different or
7021 if this is an in-out reload, recompute whether or not we
7022 still need a secondary register and what the icode should
7023 be. If we still need a secondary register and the class or
7024 icode is different, go back to reloading from OLD if using
7025 OLDEQUIV means that we got the wrong type of register. We
7026 cannot have different class or icode due to an in-out reload
7027 because we don't make such reloads when both the input and
7028 output need secondary reload registers. */
7030 if (! special && rl->secondary_in_reload >= 0)
7032 rtx second_reload_reg = 0;
7033 rtx third_reload_reg = 0;
7034 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_in_reload;
7035 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
7036 rtx real_old = old;
7037 rtx tmp;
7038 enum insn_code icode;
7039 enum insn_code tertiary_icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7041 /* If OLDEQUIV is a pseudo with a MEM, get the real MEM
7042 and similarly for OLD.
7043 See comments in get_secondary_reload in reload.c. */
7044 /* If it is a pseudo that cannot be replaced with its
7045 equivalent MEM, we must fall back to reload_in, which
7046 will have all the necessary substitutions registered.
7047 Likewise for a pseudo that can't be replaced with its
7048 equivalent constant.
7050 Take extra care for subregs of such pseudos. Note that
7051 we cannot use reg_equiv_mem in this case because it is
7052 not in the right mode. */
7054 tmp = oldequiv;
7055 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
7056 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
7057 if (REG_P (tmp)
7058 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7059 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
7060 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
7062 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
7063 || num_not_at_initial_offset
7064 || GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG)
7065 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
7066 else
7067 real_oldequiv = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
7070 tmp = old;
7071 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
7072 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
7073 if (REG_P (tmp)
7074 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7075 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)] != 0
7076 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (tmp)] != 0))
7078 if (! reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)]
7079 || num_not_at_initial_offset
7080 || GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG)
7081 real_old = rl->in;
7082 else
7083 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (tmp)];
7086 second_reload_reg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
7087 if (rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload >= 0)
7089 int tertiary_reload = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_reload;
7091 third_reload_reg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
7092 tertiary_icode = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_in_icode;
7093 /* We'd have to add more code for quartary reloads. */
7094 gcc_assert (rld[tertiary_reload].secondary_in_reload < 0);
7096 icode = rl->secondary_in_icode;
7098 if ((old != oldequiv && ! rtx_equal_p (old, oldequiv))
7099 || (rl->in != 0 && rl->out != 0))
7101 secondary_reload_info sri, sri2;
7102 enum reg_class new_class, new_t_class;
7104 sri.icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7105 sri.prev_sri = NULL;
7106 new_class = targetm.secondary_reload (1, real_oldequiv, rl->rclass,
7107 mode, &sri);
7109 if (new_class == NO_REGS && sri.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
7110 second_reload_reg = 0;
7111 else if (new_class == NO_REGS)
7113 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (&second_reload_reg,
7114 third_reload_reg, sri.icode))
7115 icode = sri.icode, third_reload_reg = 0;
7116 else
7117 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
7119 else if (sri.icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7120 /* We currently lack a way to express this in reloads. */
7121 gcc_unreachable ();
7122 else
7124 sri2.icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7125 sri2.prev_sri = &sri;
7126 new_t_class = targetm.secondary_reload (1, real_oldequiv,
7127 new_class, mode, &sri);
7128 if (new_t_class == NO_REGS && sri2.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
7130 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&second_reload_reg,
7131 third_reload_reg,
7132 new_class, mode))
7133 third_reload_reg = 0, tertiary_icode = sri2.icode;
7134 else
7135 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
7137 else if (new_t_class == NO_REGS && sri2.icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7139 rtx intermediate = second_reload_reg;
7141 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&intermediate, NULL,
7142 new_class, mode)
7143 && reload_adjust_reg_for_icode (&third_reload_reg, NULL,
7144 sri2.icode))
7146 second_reload_reg = intermediate;
7147 tertiary_icode = sri2.icode;
7149 else
7150 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
7152 else if (new_t_class != NO_REGS && sri2.icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
7154 rtx intermediate = second_reload_reg;
7156 if (reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&intermediate, NULL,
7157 new_class, mode)
7158 && reload_adjust_reg_for_temp (&third_reload_reg, NULL,
7159 new_t_class, mode))
7161 second_reload_reg = intermediate;
7162 tertiary_icode = sri2.icode;
7164 else
7165 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
7167 else
7168 /* This could be handled more intelligently too. */
7169 oldequiv = old, real_oldequiv = real_old;
7173 /* If we still need a secondary reload register, check
7174 to see if it is being used as a scratch or intermediate
7175 register and generate code appropriately. If we need
7176 a scratch register, use REAL_OLDEQUIV since the form of
7177 the insn may depend on the actual address if it is
7178 a MEM. */
7180 if (second_reload_reg)
7182 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7184 /* We'd have to add extra code to handle this case. */
7185 gcc_assert (!third_reload_reg);
7187 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (reloadreg, real_oldequiv,
7188 second_reload_reg));
7189 special = 1;
7191 else
7193 /* See if we need a scratch register to load the
7194 intermediate register (a tertiary reload). */
7195 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7197 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
7198 (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
7199 third_reload_reg)));
7201 else if (third_reload_reg)
7203 gen_reload (third_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
7204 rl->opnum,
7205 rl->when_needed);
7206 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, third_reload_reg,
7207 rl->opnum,
7208 rl->when_needed);
7210 else
7211 gen_reload (second_reload_reg, real_oldequiv,
7212 rl->opnum,
7213 rl->when_needed);
7215 oldequiv = second_reload_reg;
7220 if (! special && ! rtx_equal_p (reloadreg, oldequiv))
7222 rtx real_oldequiv = oldequiv;
7224 if ((REG_P (oldequiv)
7225 && REGNO (oldequiv) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7226 && (reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0
7227 || reg_equiv_constant[REGNO (oldequiv)] != 0))
7228 || (GET_CODE (oldequiv) == SUBREG
7229 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
7230 && (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))
7231 >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7232 && ((reg_equiv_memory_loc
7233 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0)
7234 || (reg_equiv_constant
7235 [REGNO (SUBREG_REG (oldequiv))] != 0)))
7236 || (CONSTANT_P (oldequiv)
7237 && (PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (oldequiv,
7238 REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (reloadreg)))
7239 == NO_REGS)))
7240 real_oldequiv = rl->in;
7241 gen_reload (reloadreg, real_oldequiv, rl->opnum,
7242 rl->when_needed);
7245 if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
7246 copy_eh_notes (insn, get_insns ());
7248 /* End this sequence. */
7249 *where = get_insns ();
7250 end_sequence ();
7252 /* Update reload_override_in so that delete_address_reloads_1
7253 can see the actual register usage. */
7254 if (oldequiv_reg)
7255 reload_override_in[j] = oldequiv;
7258 /* Generate insns to for the output reload RL, which is for the insn described
7259 by CHAIN and has the number J. */
7260 static void
7261 emit_output_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl,
7262 int j)
7264 rtx reloadreg;
7265 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7266 int special = 0;
7267 rtx old = rl->out;
7268 enum machine_mode mode;
7269 rtx p;
7270 rtx rl_reg_rtx;
7272 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
7273 start_sequence ();
7274 else
7275 push_to_sequence (output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
7277 rl_reg_rtx = reload_reg_rtx_for_output[j];
7278 mode = GET_MODE (rl_reg_rtx);
7280 reloadreg = rl_reg_rtx;
7282 /* If we need two reload regs, set RELOADREG to the intermediate
7283 one, since it will be stored into OLD. We might need a secondary
7284 register only for an input reload, so check again here. */
7286 if (rl->secondary_out_reload >= 0)
7288 rtx real_old = old;
7289 int secondary_reload = rl->secondary_out_reload;
7290 int tertiary_reload = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_reload;
7292 if (REG_P (old) && REGNO (old) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7293 && reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)] != 0)
7294 real_old = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (old)];
7296 if (secondary_reload_class (0, rl->rclass, mode, real_old) != NO_REGS)
7298 rtx second_reloadreg = reloadreg;
7299 reloadreg = rld[secondary_reload].reg_rtx;
7301 /* See if RELOADREG is to be used as a scratch register
7302 or as an intermediate register. */
7303 if (rl->secondary_out_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7305 /* We'd have to add extra code to handle this case. */
7306 gcc_assert (tertiary_reload < 0);
7308 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (rl->secondary_out_icode)
7309 (real_old, second_reloadreg, reloadreg)));
7310 special = 1;
7312 else
7314 /* See if we need both a scratch and intermediate reload
7315 register. */
7317 enum insn_code tertiary_icode
7318 = rld[secondary_reload].secondary_out_icode;
7320 /* We'd have to add more code for quartary reloads. */
7321 gcc_assert (tertiary_reload < 0
7322 || rld[tertiary_reload].secondary_out_reload < 0);
7324 if (GET_MODE (reloadreg) != mode)
7325 reloadreg = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reloadreg, mode);
7327 if (tertiary_icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7329 rtx third_reloadreg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
7330 rtx tem;
7332 /* Copy primary reload reg to secondary reload reg.
7333 (Note that these have been swapped above, then
7334 secondary reload reg to OLD using our insn.) */
7336 /* If REAL_OLD is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it
7337 and try to put the opposite SUBREG on
7338 RELOADREG. */
7339 if (GET_CODE (real_old) == SUBREG
7340 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (real_old))
7341 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old))))
7342 && 0 != (tem = gen_lowpart_common
7343 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (real_old)),
7344 reloadreg)))
7345 real_old = SUBREG_REG (real_old), reloadreg = tem;
7347 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
7348 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
7349 emit_insn ((GEN_FCN (tertiary_icode)
7350 (real_old, reloadreg, third_reloadreg)));
7351 special = 1;
7354 else
7356 /* Copy between the reload regs here and then to
7357 OUT later. */
7359 gen_reload (reloadreg, second_reloadreg,
7360 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
7361 if (tertiary_reload >= 0)
7363 rtx third_reloadreg = rld[tertiary_reload].reg_rtx;
7365 gen_reload (third_reloadreg, reloadreg,
7366 rl->opnum, rl->when_needed);
7367 reloadreg = third_reloadreg;
7374 /* Output the last reload insn. */
7375 if (! special)
7377 rtx set;
7379 /* Don't output the last reload if OLD is not the dest of
7380 INSN and is in the src and is clobbered by INSN. */
7381 if (! flag_expensive_optimizations
7382 || !REG_P (old)
7383 || !(set = single_set (insn))
7384 || rtx_equal_p (old, SET_DEST (set))
7385 || !reg_mentioned_p (old, SET_SRC (set))
7386 || !((REGNO (old) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7387 && regno_clobbered_p (REGNO (old), insn, rl->mode, 0)))
7388 gen_reload (old, reloadreg, rl->opnum,
7389 rl->when_needed);
7392 /* Look at all insns we emitted, just to be safe. */
7393 for (p = get_insns (); p; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
7394 if (INSN_P (p))
7396 rtx pat = PATTERN (p);
7398 /* If this output reload doesn't come from a spill reg,
7399 clear any memory of reloaded copies of the pseudo reg.
7400 If this output reload comes from a spill reg,
7401 reg_has_output_reload will make this do nothing. */
7402 note_stores (pat, forget_old_reloads_1, NULL);
7404 if (reg_mentioned_p (rl_reg_rtx, pat))
7406 rtx set = single_set (insn);
7407 if (reload_spill_index[j] < 0
7408 && set
7409 && SET_SRC (set) == rl_reg_rtx)
7411 int src = REGNO (SET_SRC (set));
7413 reload_spill_index[j] = src;
7414 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src);
7415 if (find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src))
7416 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src);
7418 if (HARD_REGISTER_P (rl_reg_rtx))
7420 int s = rl->secondary_out_reload;
7421 set = single_set (p);
7422 /* If this reload copies only to the secondary reload
7423 register, the secondary reload does the actual
7424 store. */
7425 if (s >= 0 && set == NULL_RTX)
7426 /* We can't tell what function the secondary reload
7427 has and where the actual store to the pseudo is
7428 made; leave new_spill_reg_store alone. */
7430 else if (s >= 0
7431 && SET_SRC (set) == rl_reg_rtx
7432 && SET_DEST (set) == rld[s].reg_rtx)
7434 /* Usually the next instruction will be the
7435 secondary reload insn; if we can confirm
7436 that it is, setting new_spill_reg_store to
7437 that insn will allow an extra optimization. */
7438 rtx s_reg = rld[s].reg_rtx;
7439 rtx next = NEXT_INSN (p);
7440 rld[s].out = rl->out;
7441 rld[s].out_reg = rl->out_reg;
7442 set = single_set (next);
7443 if (set && SET_SRC (set) == s_reg
7444 && ! new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)])
7446 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload,
7447 REGNO (s_reg));
7448 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (s_reg)] = next;
7451 else
7452 new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (rl_reg_rtx)] = p;
7457 if (rl->when_needed == RELOAD_OTHER)
7459 emit_insn (other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum]);
7460 other_output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
7462 else
7463 output_reload_insns[rl->opnum] = get_insns ();
7465 if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
7466 copy_eh_notes (insn, get_insns ());
7468 end_sequence ();
7471 /* Do input reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by CHAIN
7472 and has the number J. */
7473 static void
7474 do_input_reload (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl, int j)
7476 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7477 rtx old = (rl->in && MEM_P (rl->in)
7478 ? rl->in_reg : rl->in);
7479 rtx reg_rtx = rl->reg_rtx;
7481 if (old && reg_rtx)
7483 enum machine_mode mode;
7485 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
7486 This is very tricky because we have three to choose from.
7487 There is the mode the insn operand wants (rl->inmode).
7488 There is the mode of the reload register RELOADREG.
7489 There is the intrinsic mode of the operand, which we could find
7490 by stripping some SUBREGs.
7491 It turns out that RELOADREG's mode is irrelevant:
7492 we can change that arbitrarily.
7494 Consider (SUBREG:SI foo:QI) as an operand that must be SImode;
7495 then the reload reg may not support QImode moves, so use SImode.
7496 If foo is in memory due to spilling a pseudo reg, this is safe,
7497 because the QImode value is in the least significant part of a
7498 slot big enough for a SImode. If foo is some other sort of
7499 memory reference, then it is impossible to reload this case,
7500 so previous passes had better make sure this never happens.
7502 Then consider a one-word union which has SImode and one of its
7503 members is a float, being fetched as (SUBREG:SF union:SI).
7504 We must fetch that as SFmode because we could be loading into
7505 a float-only register. In this case OLD's mode is correct.
7507 Consider an immediate integer: it has VOIDmode. Here we need
7508 to get a mode from something else.
7510 In some cases, there is a fourth mode, the operand's
7511 containing mode. If the insn specifies a containing mode for
7512 this operand, it overrides all others.
7514 I am not sure whether the algorithm here is always right,
7515 but it does the right things in those cases. */
7517 mode = GET_MODE (old);
7518 if (mode == VOIDmode)
7519 mode = rl->inmode;
7521 /* We cannot use gen_lowpart_common since it can do the wrong thing
7522 when REG_RTX has a multi-word mode. Note that REG_RTX must
7523 always be a REG here. */
7524 if (GET_MODE (reg_rtx) != mode)
7525 reg_rtx = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg_rtx, mode);
7527 reload_reg_rtx_for_input[j] = reg_rtx;
7529 if (old != 0
7530 /* AUTO_INC reloads need to be handled even if inherited. We got an
7531 AUTO_INC reload if reload_out is set but reload_out_reg isn't. */
7532 && (! reload_inherited[j] || (rl->out && ! rl->out_reg))
7533 && ! rtx_equal_p (reg_rtx, old)
7534 && reg_rtx != 0)
7535 emit_input_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, old, j);
7537 /* When inheriting a wider reload, we have a MEM in rl->in,
7538 e.g. inheriting a SImode output reload for
7539 (mem:HI (plus:SI (reg:SI 14 fp) (const_int 10))) */
7540 if (optimize && reload_inherited[j] && rl->in
7541 && MEM_P (rl->in)
7542 && MEM_P (rl->in_reg)
7543 && reload_spill_index[j] >= 0
7544 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, reload_spill_index[j]))
7545 rl->in = regno_reg_rtx[reg_reloaded_contents[reload_spill_index[j]]];
7547 /* If we are reloading a register that was recently stored in with an
7548 output-reload, see if we can prove there was
7549 actually no need to store the old value in it. */
7551 if (optimize
7552 && (reload_inherited[j] || reload_override_in[j])
7553 && reg_rtx
7554 && REG_P (reg_rtx)
7555 && spill_reg_store[REGNO (reg_rtx)] != 0
7556 #if 0
7557 /* There doesn't seem to be any reason to restrict this to pseudos
7558 and doing so loses in the case where we are copying from a
7559 register of the wrong class. */
7560 && !HARD_REGISTER_P (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (reg_rtx)])
7561 #endif
7562 /* The insn might have already some references to stackslots
7563 replaced by MEMs, while reload_out_reg still names the
7564 original pseudo. */
7565 && (dead_or_set_p (insn, spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (reg_rtx)])
7566 || rtx_equal_p (spill_reg_stored_to[REGNO (reg_rtx)], rl->out_reg)))
7567 delete_output_reload (insn, j, REGNO (reg_rtx), reg_rtx);
7570 /* Do output reloading for reload RL, which is for the insn described by
7571 CHAIN and has the number J.
7572 ??? At some point we need to support handling output reloads of
7573 JUMP_INSNs or insns that set cc0. */
7574 static void
7575 do_output_reload (struct insn_chain *chain, struct reload *rl, int j)
7577 rtx note, old;
7578 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7579 /* If this is an output reload that stores something that is
7580 not loaded in this same reload, see if we can eliminate a previous
7581 store. */
7582 rtx pseudo = rl->out_reg;
7583 rtx reg_rtx = rl->reg_rtx;
7585 if (rl->out && reg_rtx)
7587 enum machine_mode mode;
7589 /* Determine the mode to reload in.
7590 See comments above (for input reloading). */
7591 mode = GET_MODE (rl->out);
7592 if (mode == VOIDmode)
7594 /* VOIDmode should never happen for an output. */
7595 if (asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) < 0)
7596 /* It's the compiler's fault. */
7597 fatal_insn ("VOIDmode on an output", insn);
7598 error_for_asm (insn, "output operand is constant in %<asm%>");
7599 /* Prevent crash--use something we know is valid. */
7600 mode = word_mode;
7601 rl->out = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reg_rtx));
7603 if (GET_MODE (reg_rtx) != mode)
7604 reg_rtx = reload_adjust_reg_for_mode (reg_rtx, mode);
7606 reload_reg_rtx_for_output[j] = reg_rtx;
7608 if (pseudo
7609 && optimize
7610 && REG_P (pseudo)
7611 && ! rtx_equal_p (rl->in_reg, pseudo)
7612 && REGNO (pseudo) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7613 && reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (pseudo)])
7615 int pseudo_no = REGNO (pseudo);
7616 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[pseudo_no]);
7618 /* We don't need to test full validity of last_regno for
7619 inherit here; we only want to know if the store actually
7620 matches the pseudo. */
7621 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, last_regno)
7622 && reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == pseudo_no
7623 && spill_reg_store[last_regno]
7624 && rtx_equal_p (pseudo, spill_reg_stored_to[last_regno]))
7625 delete_output_reload (insn, j, last_regno, reg_rtx);
7628 old = rl->out_reg;
7629 if (old == 0
7630 || reg_rtx == 0
7631 || rtx_equal_p (old, reg_rtx))
7632 return;
7634 /* An output operand that dies right away does need a reload,
7635 but need not be copied from it. Show the new location in the
7636 REG_UNUSED note. */
7637 if ((REG_P (old) || GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
7638 && (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, old)) != 0)
7640 XEXP (note, 0) = reg_rtx;
7641 return;
7643 /* Likewise for a SUBREG of an operand that dies. */
7644 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SUBREG
7645 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (old))
7646 && 0 != (note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED,
7647 SUBREG_REG (old))))
7649 XEXP (note, 0) = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (old), reg_rtx);
7650 return;
7652 else if (GET_CODE (old) == SCRATCH)
7653 /* If we aren't optimizing, there won't be a REG_UNUSED note,
7654 but we don't want to make an output reload. */
7655 return;
7657 /* If is a JUMP_INSN, we can't support output reloads yet. */
7658 gcc_assert (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn));
7660 emit_output_reload_insns (chain, rld + j, j);
7663 /* A reload copies values of MODE from register SRC to register DEST.
7664 Return true if it can be treated for inheritance purposes like a
7665 group of reloads, each one reloading a single hard register. The
7666 caller has already checked that (reg:MODE SRC) and (reg:MODE DEST)
7667 occupy the same number of hard registers. */
7669 static bool
7670 inherit_piecemeal_p (int dest ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7671 int src ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7672 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7674 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
7675 return (!REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (dest, mode, reg_raw_mode[dest])
7676 && !REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (src, mode, reg_raw_mode[src]));
7677 #else
7678 return true;
7679 #endif
7682 /* Output insns to reload values in and out of the chosen reload regs. */
7684 static void
7685 emit_reload_insns (struct insn_chain *chain)
7687 rtx insn = chain->insn;
7689 int j;
7691 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_died);
7693 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
7694 input_reload_insns[j] = input_address_reload_insns[j]
7695 = inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
7696 = output_reload_insns[j] = output_address_reload_insns[j]
7697 = outaddr_address_reload_insns[j]
7698 = other_output_reload_insns[j] = 0;
7699 other_input_address_reload_insns = 0;
7700 other_input_reload_insns = 0;
7701 operand_reload_insns = 0;
7702 other_operand_reload_insns = 0;
7704 /* Dump reloads into the dump file. */
7705 if (dump_file)
7707 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReloads for insn # %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
7708 debug_reload_to_stream (dump_file);
7711 /* Now output the instructions to copy the data into and out of the
7712 reload registers. Do these in the order that the reloads were reported,
7713 since reloads of base and index registers precede reloads of operands
7714 and the operands may need the base and index registers reloaded. */
7716 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7718 if (rld[j].reg_rtx && HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[j].reg_rtx))
7720 unsigned int i;
7722 for (i = REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx); i < END_REGNO (rld[j].reg_rtx); i++)
7723 new_spill_reg_store[i] = 0;
7726 do_input_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
7727 do_output_reload (chain, rld + j, j);
7730 /* Now write all the insns we made for reloads in the order expected by
7731 the allocation functions. Prior to the insn being reloaded, we write
7732 the following reloads:
7734 RELOAD_FOR_OTHER_ADDRESS reloads for input addresses.
7736 RELOAD_OTHER reloads.
7738 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_INPADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
7739 by any RELOAD_FOR_INPUT_ADDRESS reloads followed by the
7740 RELOAD_FOR_INPUT reload for the operand.
7742 RELOAD_FOR_OPADDR_ADDRS reloads.
7744 RELOAD_FOR_OPERAND_ADDRESS reloads.
7746 After the insn being reloaded, we write the following:
7748 For each operand, any RELOAD_FOR_OUTADDR_ADDRESS reloads followed
7749 by any RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT_ADDRESS reload followed by the
7750 RELOAD_FOR_OUTPUT reload, followed by any RELOAD_OTHER output
7751 reloads for the operand. The RELOAD_OTHER output reloads are
7752 output in descending order by reload number. */
7754 emit_insn_before (other_input_address_reload_insns, insn);
7755 emit_insn_before (other_input_reload_insns, insn);
7757 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
7759 emit_insn_before (inpaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
7760 emit_insn_before (input_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
7761 emit_insn_before (input_reload_insns[j], insn);
7764 emit_insn_before (other_operand_reload_insns, insn);
7765 emit_insn_before (operand_reload_insns, insn);
7767 for (j = 0; j < reload_n_operands; j++)
7769 rtx x = emit_insn_after (outaddr_address_reload_insns[j], insn);
7770 x = emit_insn_after (output_address_reload_insns[j], x);
7771 x = emit_insn_after (output_reload_insns[j], x);
7772 emit_insn_after (other_output_reload_insns[j], x);
7775 /* For all the spill regs newly reloaded in this instruction,
7776 record what they were reloaded from, so subsequent instructions
7777 can inherit the reloads.
7779 Update spill_reg_store for the reloads of this insn.
7780 Copy the elements that were updated in the loop above. */
7782 for (j = 0; j < n_reloads; j++)
7784 int r = reload_order[j];
7785 int i = reload_spill_index[r];
7787 /* If this is a non-inherited input reload from a pseudo, we must
7788 clear any memory of a previous store to the same pseudo. Only do
7789 something if there will not be an output reload for the pseudo
7790 being reloaded. */
7791 if (rld[r].in_reg != 0
7792 && ! (reload_inherited[r] || reload_override_in[r]))
7794 rtx reg = rld[r].in_reg;
7796 if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
7797 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
7799 if (REG_P (reg)
7800 && REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7801 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload, REGNO (reg)))
7803 int nregno = REGNO (reg);
7805 if (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno])
7807 int last_regno = REGNO (reg_last_reload_reg[nregno]);
7809 if (reg_reloaded_contents[last_regno] == nregno)
7810 spill_reg_store[last_regno] = 0;
7815 /* I is nonneg if this reload used a register.
7816 If rld[r].reg_rtx is 0, this is an optional reload
7817 that we opted to ignore. */
7819 if (i >= 0 && rld[r].reg_rtx != 0)
7821 int nr = hard_regno_nregs[i][GET_MODE (rld[r].reg_rtx)];
7822 int k;
7824 /* For a multi register reload, we need to check if all or part
7825 of the value lives to the end. */
7826 for (k = 0; k < nr; k++)
7827 if (reload_reg_reaches_end_p (i + k, rld[r].opnum,
7828 rld[r].when_needed))
7829 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, i + k);
7831 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_out. */
7832 if (rld[r].out != 0
7833 && (REG_P (rld[r].out)
7834 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
7835 || ! rld[r].out_reg
7836 #endif
7837 || REG_P (rld[r].out_reg)))
7839 rtx reg;
7840 enum machine_mode mode;
7841 int regno, nregs;
7843 reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_output[r];
7844 mode = GET_MODE (reg);
7845 regno = REGNO (reg);
7846 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
7847 if (reload_regs_reach_end_p (regno, nregs, rld[r].opnum,
7848 rld[r].when_needed))
7850 rtx out = (REG_P (rld[r].out)
7851 ? rld[r].out
7852 : rld[r].out_reg
7853 ? rld[r].out_reg
7854 /* AUTO_INC */ : XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0));
7855 int out_regno = REGNO (out);
7856 int out_nregs = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno) ? 1
7857 : hard_regno_nregs[out_regno][mode]);
7858 bool piecemeal;
7860 spill_reg_store[regno] = new_spill_reg_store[regno];
7861 spill_reg_stored_to[regno] = out;
7862 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno] = reg;
7864 piecemeal = (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno)
7865 && nregs == out_nregs
7866 && inherit_piecemeal_p (out_regno, regno, mode));
7868 /* If OUT_REGNO is a hard register, it may occupy more than
7869 one register. If it does, say what is in the
7870 rest of the registers assuming that both registers
7871 agree on how many words the object takes. If not,
7872 invalidate the subsequent registers. */
7874 if (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno))
7875 for (k = 1; k < out_nregs; k++)
7876 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno + k]
7877 = (piecemeal ? regno_reg_rtx[regno + k] : 0);
7879 /* Now do the inverse operation. */
7880 for (k = 0; k < nregs; k++)
7882 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, regno + k);
7883 reg_reloaded_contents[regno + k]
7884 = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno) || !piecemeal
7885 ? out_regno
7886 : out_regno + k);
7887 reg_reloaded_insn[regno + k] = insn;
7888 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + k);
7889 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (regno + k, mode))
7890 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
7891 regno + k);
7892 else
7893 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
7894 regno + k);
7898 /* Maybe the spill reg contains a copy of reload_in. Only do
7899 something if there will not be an output reload for
7900 the register being reloaded. */
7901 else if (rld[r].out_reg == 0
7902 && rld[r].in != 0
7903 && ((REG_P (rld[r].in)
7904 && !HARD_REGISTER_P (rld[r].in)
7905 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload,
7906 REGNO (rld[r].in)))
7907 || (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg)
7908 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (&reg_has_output_reload,
7909 REGNO (rld[r].in_reg))))
7910 && !reg_set_p (reload_reg_rtx_for_input[r], PATTERN (insn)))
7912 rtx reg;
7913 enum machine_mode mode;
7914 int regno, nregs;
7916 reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_input[r];
7917 mode = GET_MODE (reg);
7918 regno = REGNO (reg);
7919 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode];
7920 if (reload_regs_reach_end_p (regno, nregs, rld[r].opnum,
7921 rld[r].when_needed))
7923 int in_regno;
7924 int in_nregs;
7925 rtx in;
7926 bool piecemeal;
7928 if (REG_P (rld[r].in)
7929 && REGNO (rld[r].in) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7930 in = rld[r].in;
7931 else if (REG_P (rld[r].in_reg))
7932 in = rld[r].in_reg;
7933 else
7934 in = XEXP (rld[r].in_reg, 0);
7935 in_regno = REGNO (in);
7937 in_nregs = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno) ? 1
7938 : hard_regno_nregs[in_regno][mode]);
7940 reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno] = reg;
7942 piecemeal = (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno)
7943 && nregs == in_nregs
7944 && inherit_piecemeal_p (regno, in_regno, mode));
7946 if (HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno))
7947 for (k = 1; k < in_nregs; k++)
7948 reg_last_reload_reg[in_regno + k]
7949 = (piecemeal ? regno_reg_rtx[regno + k] : 0);
7951 /* Unless we inherited this reload, show we haven't
7952 recently done a store.
7953 Previous stores of inherited auto_inc expressions
7954 also have to be discarded. */
7955 if (! reload_inherited[r]
7956 || (rld[r].out && ! rld[r].out_reg))
7957 spill_reg_store[regno] = 0;
7959 for (k = 0; k < nregs; k++)
7961 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, regno + k);
7962 reg_reloaded_contents[regno + k]
7963 = (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (in_regno) || !piecemeal
7964 ? in_regno
7965 : in_regno + k);
7966 reg_reloaded_insn[regno + k] = insn;
7967 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, regno + k);
7968 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (regno + k, mode))
7969 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
7970 regno + k);
7971 else
7972 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
7973 regno + k);
7979 /* The following if-statement was #if 0'd in 1.34 (or before...).
7980 It's reenabled in 1.35 because supposedly nothing else
7981 deals with this problem. */
7983 /* If a register gets output-reloaded from a non-spill register,
7984 that invalidates any previous reloaded copy of it.
7985 But forget_old_reloads_1 won't get to see it, because
7986 it thinks only about the original insn. So invalidate it here.
7987 Also do the same thing for RELOAD_OTHER constraints where the
7988 output is discarded. */
7989 if (i < 0
7990 && ((rld[r].out != 0
7991 && (REG_P (rld[r].out)
7992 || (MEM_P (rld[r].out)
7993 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg))))
7994 || (rld[r].out == 0 && rld[r].out_reg
7995 && REG_P (rld[r].out_reg))))
7997 rtx out = ((rld[r].out && REG_P (rld[r].out))
7998 ? rld[r].out : rld[r].out_reg);
7999 int out_regno = REGNO (out);
8000 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (out);
8002 /* REG_RTX is now set or clobbered by the main instruction.
8003 As the comment above explains, forget_old_reloads_1 only
8004 sees the original instruction, and there is no guarantee
8005 that the original instruction also clobbered REG_RTX.
8006 For example, if find_reloads sees that the input side of
8007 a matched operand pair dies in this instruction, it may
8008 use the input register as the reload register.
8010 Calling forget_old_reloads_1 is a waste of effort if
8011 REG_RTX is also the output register.
8013 If we know that REG_RTX holds the value of a pseudo
8014 register, the code after the call will record that fact. */
8015 if (rld[r].reg_rtx && rld[r].reg_rtx != out)
8016 forget_old_reloads_1 (rld[r].reg_rtx, NULL_RTX, NULL);
8018 if (!HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (out_regno))
8020 rtx src_reg, store_insn = NULL_RTX;
8022 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno] = 0;
8024 /* If we can find a hard register that is stored, record
8025 the storing insn so that we may delete this insn with
8026 delete_output_reload. */
8027 src_reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_output[r];
8029 /* If this is an optional reload, try to find the source reg
8030 from an input reload. */
8031 if (! src_reg)
8033 rtx set = single_set (insn);
8034 if (set && SET_DEST (set) == rld[r].out)
8036 int k;
8038 src_reg = SET_SRC (set);
8039 store_insn = insn;
8040 for (k = 0; k < n_reloads; k++)
8042 if (rld[k].in == src_reg)
8044 src_reg = reload_reg_rtx_for_input[k];
8045 break;
8050 else
8051 store_insn = new_spill_reg_store[REGNO (src_reg)];
8052 if (src_reg && REG_P (src_reg)
8053 && REGNO (src_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8055 int src_regno, src_nregs, k;
8056 rtx note;
8058 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (src_reg) == mode);
8059 src_regno = REGNO (src_reg);
8060 src_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[src_regno][mode];
8061 /* The place where to find a death note varies with
8062 PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P . The condition is not
8063 necessarily checked exactly in the code that moves
8064 notes, so just check both locations. */
8065 note = find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
8066 if (! note && store_insn)
8067 note = find_regno_note (store_insn, REG_DEAD, src_regno);
8068 for (k = 0; k < src_nregs; k++)
8070 spill_reg_store[src_regno + k] = store_insn;
8071 spill_reg_stored_to[src_regno + k] = out;
8072 reg_reloaded_contents[src_regno + k] = out_regno;
8073 reg_reloaded_insn[src_regno + k] = store_insn;
8074 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_dead, src_regno + k);
8075 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_valid, src_regno + k);
8076 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (src_regno + k,
8077 mode))
8078 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8079 src_regno + k);
8080 else
8081 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_call_part_clobbered,
8082 src_regno + k);
8083 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_is_output_reload, src_regno + k);
8084 if (note)
8085 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
8086 else
8087 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_reloaded_died, src_regno);
8089 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno] = src_reg;
8090 /* We have to set reg_has_output_reload here, or else
8091 forget_old_reloads_1 will clear reg_last_reload_reg
8092 right away. */
8093 SET_REGNO_REG_SET (&reg_has_output_reload,
8094 out_regno);
8097 else
8099 int k, out_nregs = hard_regno_nregs[out_regno][mode];
8101 for (k = 0; k < out_nregs; k++)
8102 reg_last_reload_reg[out_regno + k] = 0;
8106 IOR_HARD_REG_SET (reg_reloaded_dead, reg_reloaded_died);
8109 /* Go through the motions to emit INSN and test if it is strictly valid.
8110 Return the emitted insn if valid, else return NULL. */
8112 static rtx
8113 emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (rtx insn)
8115 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
8116 int code;
8118 insn = emit_insn (insn);
8119 code = recog_memoized (insn);
8121 if (code >= 0)
8123 extract_insn (insn);
8124 /* We want constrain operands to treat this insn strictly in its
8125 validity determination, i.e., the way it would after reload has
8126 completed. */
8127 if (constrain_operands (1))
8128 return insn;
8131 delete_insns_since (last);
8132 return NULL;
8135 /* Emit code to perform a reload from IN (which may be a reload register) to
8136 OUT (which may also be a reload register). IN or OUT is from operand
8137 OPNUM with reload type TYPE.
8139 Returns first insn emitted. */
8141 static rtx
8142 gen_reload (rtx out, rtx in, int opnum, enum reload_type type)
8144 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
8145 rtx tem;
8147 /* If IN is a paradoxical SUBREG, remove it and try to put the
8148 opposite SUBREG on OUT. Likewise for a paradoxical SUBREG on OUT. */
8149 if (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG
8150 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (in))
8151 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in))))
8152 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (in)), out)) != 0)
8153 in = SUBREG_REG (in), out = tem;
8154 else if (GET_CODE (out) == SUBREG
8155 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (out))
8156 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out))))
8157 && (tem = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (out)), in)) != 0)
8158 out = SUBREG_REG (out), in = tem;
8160 /* How to do this reload can get quite tricky. Normally, we are being
8161 asked to reload a simple operand, such as a MEM, a constant, or a pseudo
8162 register that didn't get a hard register. In that case we can just
8163 call emit_move_insn.
8165 We can also be asked to reload a PLUS that adds a register or a MEM to
8166 another register, constant or MEM. This can occur during frame pointer
8167 elimination and while reloading addresses. This case is handled by
8168 trying to emit a single insn to perform the add. If it is not valid,
8169 we use a two insn sequence.
8171 Or we can be asked to reload an unary operand that was a fragment of
8172 an addressing mode, into a register. If it isn't recognized as-is,
8173 we try making the unop operand and the reload-register the same:
8174 (set reg:X (unop:X expr:Y))
8175 -> (set reg:Y expr:Y) (set reg:X (unop:X reg:Y)).
8177 Finally, we could be called to handle an 'o' constraint by putting
8178 an address into a register. In that case, we first try to do this
8179 with a named pattern of "reload_load_address". If no such pattern
8180 exists, we just emit a SET insn and hope for the best (it will normally
8181 be valid on machines that use 'o').
8183 This entire process is made complex because reload will never
8184 process the insns we generate here and so we must ensure that
8185 they will fit their constraints and also by the fact that parts of
8186 IN might be being reloaded separately and replaced with spill registers.
8187 Because of this, we are, in some sense, just guessing the right approach
8188 here. The one listed above seems to work.
8190 ??? At some point, this whole thing needs to be rethought. */
8192 if (GET_CODE (in) == PLUS
8193 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 0))
8194 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 0)) == SUBREG
8195 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 0)))
8196 && (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
8197 || GET_CODE (XEXP (in, 1)) == SUBREG
8198 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (in, 1))
8199 || MEM_P (XEXP (in, 1))))
8201 /* We need to compute the sum of a register or a MEM and another
8202 register, constant, or MEM, and put it into the reload
8203 register. The best possible way of doing this is if the machine
8204 has a three-operand ADD insn that accepts the required operands.
8206 The simplest approach is to try to generate such an insn and see if it
8207 is recognized and matches its constraints. If so, it can be used.
8209 It might be better not to actually emit the insn unless it is valid,
8210 but we need to pass the insn as an operand to `recog' and
8211 `extract_insn' and it is simpler to emit and then delete the insn if
8212 not valid than to dummy things up. */
8214 rtx op0, op1, tem, insn;
8215 int code;
8217 op0 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
8218 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 1));
8220 /* Since constraint checking is strict, commutativity won't be
8221 checked, so we need to do that here to avoid spurious failure
8222 if the add instruction is two-address and the second operand
8223 of the add is the same as the reload reg, which is frequently
8224 the case. If the insn would be A = B + A, rearrange it so
8225 it will be A = A + B as constrain_operands expects. */
8227 if (REG_P (XEXP (in, 1))
8228 && REGNO (out) == REGNO (XEXP (in, 1)))
8229 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
8231 if (op0 != XEXP (in, 0) || op1 != XEXP (in, 1))
8232 in = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (in), op0, op1);
8234 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
8235 if (insn)
8236 return insn;
8238 /* If that failed, we must use a conservative two-insn sequence.
8240 Use a move to copy one operand into the reload register. Prefer
8241 to reload a constant, MEM or pseudo since the move patterns can
8242 handle an arbitrary operand. If OP1 is not a constant, MEM or
8243 pseudo and OP1 is not a valid operand for an add instruction, then
8244 reload OP1.
8246 After reloading one of the operands into the reload register, add
8247 the reload register to the output register.
8249 If there is another way to do this for a specific machine, a
8250 DEFINE_PEEPHOLE should be specified that recognizes the sequence
8251 we emit below. */
8253 code = (int) optab_handler (add_optab, GET_MODE (out))->insn_code;
8255 if (CONSTANT_P (op1) || MEM_P (op1) || GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG
8256 || (REG_P (op1)
8257 && REGNO (op1) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8258 || (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
8259 && ! ((*insn_data[code].operand[2].predicate)
8260 (op1, insn_data[code].operand[2].mode))))
8261 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
8263 gen_reload (out, op0, opnum, type);
8265 /* If OP0 and OP1 are the same, we can use OUT for OP1.
8266 This fixes a problem on the 32K where the stack pointer cannot
8267 be used as an operand of an add insn. */
8269 if (rtx_equal_p (op0, op1))
8270 op1 = out;
8272 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_add2_insn (out, op1));
8273 if (insn)
8275 /* Add a REG_EQUIV note so that find_equiv_reg can find it. */
8276 set_unique_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, in);
8277 return insn;
8280 /* If that failed, copy the address register to the reload register.
8281 Then add the constant to the reload register. */
8283 gcc_assert (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (out, op0));
8284 gen_reload (out, op1, opnum, type);
8285 insn = emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (out, op0));
8286 set_unique_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, in);
8289 #ifdef SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
8290 /* If we need a memory location to do the move, do it that way. */
8291 else if ((REG_P (in)
8292 || (GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (in))))
8293 && reg_or_subregno (in) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8294 && (REG_P (out)
8295 || (GET_CODE (out) == SUBREG && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (out))))
8296 && reg_or_subregno (out) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8297 && SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (REGNO_REG_CLASS (reg_or_subregno (in)),
8298 REGNO_REG_CLASS (reg_or_subregno (out)),
8299 GET_MODE (out)))
8301 /* Get the memory to use and rewrite both registers to its mode. */
8302 rtx loc = get_secondary_mem (in, GET_MODE (out), opnum, type);
8304 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (out))
8305 out = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (out));
8307 if (GET_MODE (loc) != GET_MODE (in))
8308 in = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (loc), REGNO (in));
8310 gen_reload (loc, in, opnum, type);
8311 gen_reload (out, loc, opnum, type);
8313 #endif
8314 else if (REG_P (out) && UNARY_P (in))
8316 rtx insn;
8317 rtx op1;
8318 rtx out_moded;
8319 rtx set;
8321 op1 = find_replacement (&XEXP (in, 0));
8322 if (op1 != XEXP (in, 0))
8323 in = gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (in), GET_MODE (in), op1);
8325 /* First, try a plain SET. */
8326 set = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
8327 if (set)
8328 return set;
8330 /* If that failed, move the inner operand to the reload
8331 register, and try the same unop with the inner expression
8332 replaced with the reload register. */
8334 if (GET_MODE (op1) != GET_MODE (out))
8335 out_moded = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (op1), REGNO (out));
8336 else
8337 out_moded = out;
8339 gen_reload (out_moded, op1, opnum, type);
8341 insn
8342 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out,
8343 gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (in), GET_MODE (in),
8344 out_moded));
8345 insn = emit_insn_if_valid_for_reload (insn);
8346 if (insn)
8348 set_unique_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, in);
8349 return insn;
8352 fatal_insn ("Failure trying to reload:", set);
8354 /* If IN is a simple operand, use gen_move_insn. */
8355 else if (OBJECT_P (in) || GET_CODE (in) == SUBREG)
8357 tem = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (out, in));
8358 /* IN may contain a LABEL_REF, if so add a REG_LABEL_OPERAND note. */
8359 mark_jump_label (in, tem, 0);
8362 #ifdef HAVE_reload_load_address
8363 else if (HAVE_reload_load_address)
8364 emit_insn (gen_reload_load_address (out, in));
8365 #endif
8367 /* Otherwise, just write (set OUT IN) and hope for the best. */
8368 else
8369 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, in));
8371 /* Return the first insn emitted.
8372 We can not just return get_last_insn, because there may have
8373 been multiple instructions emitted. Also note that gen_move_insn may
8374 emit more than one insn itself, so we can not assume that there is one
8375 insn emitted per emit_insn_before call. */
8377 return last ? NEXT_INSN (last) : get_insns ();
8380 /* Delete a previously made output-reload whose result we now believe
8381 is not needed. First we double-check.
8383 INSN is the insn now being processed.
8384 LAST_RELOAD_REG is the hard register number for which we want to delete
8385 the last output reload.
8386 J is the reload-number that originally used REG. The caller has made
8387 certain that reload J doesn't use REG any longer for input.
8388 NEW_RELOAD_REG is reload register that reload J is using for REG. */
8390 static void
8391 delete_output_reload (rtx insn, int j, int last_reload_reg, rtx new_reload_reg)
8393 rtx output_reload_insn = spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg];
8394 rtx reg = spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg];
8395 int k;
8396 int n_occurrences;
8397 int n_inherited = 0;
8398 rtx i1;
8399 rtx substed;
8401 /* It is possible that this reload has been only used to set another reload
8402 we eliminated earlier and thus deleted this instruction too. */
8403 if (INSN_DELETED_P (output_reload_insn))
8404 return;
8406 /* Get the raw pseudo-register referred to. */
8408 while (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG)
8409 reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
8410 substed = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (reg)];
8412 /* This is unsafe if the operand occurs more often in the current
8413 insn than it is inherited. */
8414 for (k = n_reloads - 1; k >= 0; k--)
8416 rtx reg2 = rld[k].in;
8417 if (! reg2)
8418 continue;
8419 if (MEM_P (reg2) || reload_override_in[k])
8420 reg2 = rld[k].in_reg;
8421 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
8422 if (rld[k].out && ! rld[k].out_reg)
8423 reg2 = XEXP (rld[k].in_reg, 0);
8424 #endif
8425 while (GET_CODE (reg2) == SUBREG)
8426 reg2 = SUBREG_REG (reg2);
8427 if (rtx_equal_p (reg2, reg))
8429 if (reload_inherited[k] || reload_override_in[k] || k == j)
8430 n_inherited++;
8431 else
8432 return;
8435 n_occurrences = count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), reg, 0);
8436 if (CALL_P (insn) && CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn))
8437 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
8438 reg, 0);
8439 if (substed)
8440 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn),
8441 eliminate_regs (substed, 0,
8442 NULL_RTX), 0);
8443 for (i1 = reg_equiv_alt_mem_list[REGNO (reg)]; i1; i1 = XEXP (i1, 1))
8445 gcc_assert (!rtx_equal_p (XEXP (i1, 0), substed));
8446 n_occurrences += count_occurrences (PATTERN (insn), XEXP (i1, 0), 0);
8448 if (n_occurrences > n_inherited)
8449 return;
8451 /* If the pseudo-reg we are reloading is no longer referenced
8452 anywhere between the store into it and here,
8453 and we're within the same basic block, then the value can only
8454 pass through the reload reg and end up here.
8455 Otherwise, give up--return. */
8456 for (i1 = NEXT_INSN (output_reload_insn);
8457 i1 != insn; i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1))
8459 if (NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK_P (i1))
8460 return;
8461 if ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (i1) || CALL_P (i1))
8462 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i1)))
8464 /* If this is USE in front of INSN, we only have to check that
8465 there are no more references than accounted for by inheritance. */
8466 while (NONJUMP_INSN_P (i1) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i1)) == USE)
8468 n_occurrences += rtx_equal_p (reg, XEXP (PATTERN (i1), 0)) != 0;
8469 i1 = NEXT_INSN (i1);
8471 if (n_occurrences <= n_inherited && i1 == insn)
8472 break;
8473 return;
8477 /* We will be deleting the insn. Remove the spill reg information. */
8478 for (k = hard_regno_nregs[last_reload_reg][GET_MODE (reg)]; k-- > 0; )
8480 spill_reg_store[last_reload_reg + k] = 0;
8481 spill_reg_stored_to[last_reload_reg + k] = 0;
8484 /* The caller has already checked that REG dies or is set in INSN.
8485 It has also checked that we are optimizing, and thus some
8486 inaccuracies in the debugging information are acceptable.
8487 So we could just delete output_reload_insn. But in some cases
8488 we can improve the debugging information without sacrificing
8489 optimization - maybe even improving the code: See if the pseudo
8490 reg has been completely replaced with reload regs. If so, delete
8491 the store insn and forget we had a stack slot for the pseudo. */
8492 if (rld[j].out != rld[j].in
8493 && REG_N_DEATHS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
8494 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (reg)) == 1
8495 && REG_BASIC_BLOCK (REGNO (reg)) >= NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS
8496 && find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, REGNO (reg)))
8498 rtx i2;
8500 /* We know that it was used only between here and the beginning of
8501 the current basic block. (We also know that the last use before
8502 INSN was the output reload we are thinking of deleting, but never
8503 mind that.) Search that range; see if any ref remains. */
8504 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
8506 rtx set = single_set (i2);
8508 /* Uses which just store in the pseudo don't count,
8509 since if they are the only uses, they are dead. */
8510 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
8511 continue;
8512 if (LABEL_P (i2)
8513 || JUMP_P (i2))
8514 break;
8515 if ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (i2) || CALL_P (i2))
8516 && reg_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (i2)))
8518 /* Some other ref remains; just delete the output reload we
8519 know to be dead. */
8520 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
8521 delete_insn (output_reload_insn);
8522 return;
8526 /* Delete the now-dead stores into this pseudo. Note that this
8527 loop also takes care of deleting output_reload_insn. */
8528 for (i2 = PREV_INSN (insn); i2; i2 = PREV_INSN (i2))
8530 rtx set = single_set (i2);
8532 if (set != 0 && SET_DEST (set) == reg)
8534 delete_address_reloads (i2, insn);
8535 delete_insn (i2);
8537 if (LABEL_P (i2)
8538 || JUMP_P (i2))
8539 break;
8542 /* For the debugging info, say the pseudo lives in this reload reg. */
8543 reg_renumber[REGNO (reg)] = REGNO (new_reload_reg);
8544 if (flag_ira && ira_conflicts_p)
8545 /* Inform IRA about the change. */
8546 ira_mark_allocation_change (REGNO (reg));
8547 alter_reg (REGNO (reg), -1, false);
8549 else
8551 delete_address_reloads (output_reload_insn, insn);
8552 delete_insn (output_reload_insn);
8556 /* We are going to delete DEAD_INSN. Recursively delete loads of
8557 reload registers used in DEAD_INSN that are not used till CURRENT_INSN.
8558 CURRENT_INSN is being reloaded, so we have to check its reloads too. */
8559 static void
8560 delete_address_reloads (rtx dead_insn, rtx current_insn)
8562 rtx set = single_set (dead_insn);
8563 rtx set2, dst, prev, next;
8564 if (set)
8566 rtx dst = SET_DEST (set);
8567 if (MEM_P (dst))
8568 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (dst, 0), current_insn);
8570 /* If we deleted the store from a reloaded post_{in,de}c expression,
8571 we can delete the matching adds. */
8572 prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn);
8573 next = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn);
8574 if (! prev || ! next)
8575 return;
8576 set = single_set (next);
8577 set2 = single_set (prev);
8578 if (! set || ! set2
8579 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) != PLUS || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set2)) != PLUS
8580 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) != CONST_INT
8581 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1)) != CONST_INT)
8582 return;
8583 dst = SET_DEST (set);
8584 if (! rtx_equal_p (dst, SET_DEST (set2))
8585 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0))
8586 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 0))
8587 || (INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1))
8588 != -INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set2), 1))))
8589 return;
8590 delete_related_insns (prev);
8591 delete_related_insns (next);
8594 /* Subfunction of delete_address_reloads: process registers found in X. */
8595 static void
8596 delete_address_reloads_1 (rtx dead_insn, rtx x, rtx current_insn)
8598 rtx prev, set, dst, i2;
8599 int i, j;
8600 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
8602 if (code != REG)
8604 const char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
8605 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8607 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
8608 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XEXP (x, i), current_insn);
8609 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
8611 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8612 delete_address_reloads_1 (dead_insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j),
8613 current_insn);
8616 return;
8619 if (spill_reg_order[REGNO (x)] < 0)
8620 return;
8622 /* Scan backwards for the insn that sets x. This might be a way back due
8623 to inheritance. */
8624 for (prev = PREV_INSN (dead_insn); prev; prev = PREV_INSN (prev))
8626 code = GET_CODE (prev);
8627 if (code == CODE_LABEL || code == JUMP_INSN)
8628 return;
8629 if (!INSN_P (prev))
8630 continue;
8631 if (reg_set_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
8632 break;
8633 if (reg_referenced_p (x, PATTERN (prev)))
8634 return;
8636 if (! prev || INSN_UID (prev) < reload_first_uid)
8637 return;
8638 /* Check that PREV only sets the reload register. */
8639 set = single_set (prev);
8640 if (! set)
8641 return;
8642 dst = SET_DEST (set);
8643 if (!REG_P (dst)
8644 || ! rtx_equal_p (dst, x))
8645 return;
8646 if (! reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (dead_insn)))
8648 /* Check if DST was used in a later insn -
8649 it might have been inherited. */
8650 for (i2 = NEXT_INSN (dead_insn); i2; i2 = NEXT_INSN (i2))
8652 if (LABEL_P (i2))
8653 break;
8654 if (! INSN_P (i2))
8655 continue;
8656 if (reg_referenced_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
8658 /* If there is a reference to the register in the current insn,
8659 it might be loaded in a non-inherited reload. If no other
8660 reload uses it, that means the register is set before
8661 referenced. */
8662 if (i2 == current_insn)
8664 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8665 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
8666 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
8667 return;
8668 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8669 if (rld[j].in && rld[j].reg_rtx == dst)
8670 break;
8671 if (j >= 0)
8672 break;
8674 return;
8676 if (JUMP_P (i2))
8677 break;
8678 /* If DST is still live at CURRENT_INSN, check if it is used for
8679 any reload. Note that even if CURRENT_INSN sets DST, we still
8680 have to check the reloads. */
8681 if (i2 == current_insn)
8683 for (j = n_reloads - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8684 if ((rld[j].reg_rtx == dst && reload_inherited[j])
8685 || reload_override_in[j] == dst)
8686 return;
8687 /* ??? We can't finish the loop here, because dst might be
8688 allocated to a pseudo in this block if no reload in this
8689 block needs any of the classes containing DST - see
8690 spill_hard_reg. There is no easy way to tell this, so we
8691 have to scan till the end of the basic block. */
8693 if (reg_set_p (dst, PATTERN (i2)))
8694 break;
8697 delete_address_reloads_1 (prev, SET_SRC (set), current_insn);
8698 reg_reloaded_contents[REGNO (dst)] = -1;
8699 delete_insn (prev);
8702 /* Output reload-insns to reload VALUE into RELOADREG.
8703 VALUE is an autoincrement or autodecrement RTX whose operand
8704 is a register or memory location;
8705 so reloading involves incrementing that location.
8706 IN is either identical to VALUE, or some cheaper place to reload from.
8708 INC_AMOUNT is the number to increment or decrement by (always positive).
8709 This cannot be deduced from VALUE.
8711 Return the instruction that stores into RELOADREG. */
8713 static rtx
8714 inc_for_reload (rtx reloadreg, rtx in, rtx value, int inc_amount)
8716 /* REG or MEM to be copied and incremented. */
8717 rtx incloc = find_replacement (&XEXP (value, 0));
8718 /* Nonzero if increment after copying. */
8719 int post = (GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_INC
8720 || GET_CODE (value) == POST_MODIFY);
8721 rtx last;
8722 rtx inc;
8723 rtx add_insn;
8724 int code;
8725 rtx store;
8726 rtx real_in = in == value ? incloc : in;
8728 /* No hard register is equivalent to this register after
8729 inc/dec operation. If REG_LAST_RELOAD_REG were nonzero,
8730 we could inc/dec that register as well (maybe even using it for
8731 the source), but I'm not sure it's worth worrying about. */
8732 if (REG_P (incloc))
8733 reg_last_reload_reg[REGNO (incloc)] = 0;
8735 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_MODIFY || GET_CODE (value) == POST_MODIFY)
8737 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == PLUS);
8738 inc = find_replacement (&XEXP (XEXP (value, 1), 1));
8740 else
8742 if (GET_CODE (value) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (value) == POST_DEC)
8743 inc_amount = -inc_amount;
8745 inc = GEN_INT (inc_amount);
8748 /* If this is post-increment, first copy the location to the reload reg. */
8749 if (post && real_in != reloadreg)
8750 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
8752 if (in == value)
8754 /* See if we can directly increment INCLOC. Use a method similar to
8755 that in gen_reload. */
8757 last = get_last_insn ();
8758 add_insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, incloc,
8759 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (incloc),
8760 incloc, inc)));
8762 code = recog_memoized (add_insn);
8763 if (code >= 0)
8765 extract_insn (add_insn);
8766 if (constrain_operands (1))
8768 /* If this is a pre-increment and we have incremented the value
8769 where it lives, copy the incremented value to RELOADREG to
8770 be used as an address. */
8772 if (! post)
8773 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, incloc));
8775 return add_insn;
8778 delete_insns_since (last);
8781 /* If couldn't do the increment directly, must increment in RELOADREG.
8782 The way we do this depends on whether this is pre- or post-increment.
8783 For pre-increment, copy INCLOC to the reload register, increment it
8784 there, then save back. */
8786 if (! post)
8788 if (in != reloadreg)
8789 emit_insn (gen_move_insn (reloadreg, real_in));
8790 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
8791 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
8793 else
8795 /* Postincrement.
8796 Because this might be a jump insn or a compare, and because RELOADREG
8797 may not be available after the insn in an input reload, we must do
8798 the incrementation before the insn being reloaded for.
8800 We have already copied IN to RELOADREG. Increment the copy in
8801 RELOADREG, save that back, then decrement RELOADREG so it has
8802 the original value. */
8804 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
8805 store = emit_insn (gen_move_insn (incloc, reloadreg));
8806 if (GET_CODE (inc) == CONST_INT)
8807 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (reloadreg, GEN_INT (-INTVAL (inc))));
8808 else
8809 emit_insn (gen_sub2_insn (reloadreg, inc));
8812 return store;
8815 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
8816 static void
8817 add_auto_inc_notes (rtx insn, rtx x)
8819 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
8820 const char *fmt;
8821 int i, j;
8823 if (code == MEM && auto_inc_p (XEXP (x, 0)))
8825 add_reg_note (insn, REG_INC, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
8826 return;
8829 /* Scan all the operand sub-expressions. */
8830 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
8831 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8833 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
8834 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XEXP (x, i));
8835 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
8836 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8837 add_auto_inc_notes (insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j));
8840 #endif
8842 /* Copy EH notes from an insn to its reloads. */
8843 static void
8844 copy_eh_notes (rtx insn, rtx x)
8846 rtx eh_note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX);
8847 if (eh_note)
8849 for (; x != 0; x = NEXT_INSN (x))
8851 if (may_trap_p (PATTERN (x)))
8852 add_reg_note (x, REG_EH_REGION, XEXP (eh_note, 0));
8857 /* This is used by reload pass, that does emit some instructions after
8858 abnormal calls moving basic block end, but in fact it wants to emit
8859 them on the edge. Looks for abnormal call edges, find backward the
8860 proper call and fix the damage.
8862 Similar handle instructions throwing exceptions internally. */
8863 void
8864 fixup_abnormal_edges (void)
8866 bool inserted = false;
8867 basic_block bb;
8869 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
8871 edge e;
8872 edge_iterator ei;
8874 /* Look for cases we are interested in - calls or instructions causing
8875 exceptions. */
8876 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
8878 if (e->flags & EDGE_ABNORMAL_CALL)
8879 break;
8880 if ((e->flags & (EDGE_ABNORMAL | EDGE_EH))
8881 == (EDGE_ABNORMAL | EDGE_EH))
8882 break;
8884 if (e && !CALL_P (BB_END (bb))
8885 && !can_throw_internal (BB_END (bb)))
8887 rtx insn;
8889 /* Get past the new insns generated. Allow notes, as the insns
8890 may be already deleted. */
8891 insn = BB_END (bb);
8892 while ((NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || NOTE_P (insn))
8893 && !can_throw_internal (insn)
8894 && insn != BB_HEAD (bb))
8895 insn = PREV_INSN (insn);
8897 if (CALL_P (insn) || can_throw_internal (insn))
8899 rtx stop, next;
8901 stop = NEXT_INSN (BB_END (bb));
8902 BB_END (bb) = insn;
8903 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
8905 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
8906 if (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU)
8907 break;
8909 while (insn && insn != stop)
8911 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
8912 if (INSN_P (insn))
8914 delete_insn (insn);
8916 /* Sometimes there's still the return value USE.
8917 If it's placed after a trapping call (i.e. that
8918 call is the last insn anyway), we have no fallthru
8919 edge. Simply delete this use and don't try to insert
8920 on the non-existent edge. */
8921 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE)
8923 /* We're not deleting it, we're moving it. */
8924 INSN_DELETED_P (insn) = 0;
8925 PREV_INSN (insn) = NULL_RTX;
8926 NEXT_INSN (insn) = NULL_RTX;
8928 insert_insn_on_edge (insn, e);
8929 inserted = true;
8932 else if (!BARRIER_P (insn))
8933 set_block_for_insn (insn, NULL);
8934 insn = next;
8938 /* It may be that we don't find any such trapping insn. In this
8939 case we discovered quite late that the insn that had been
8940 marked as can_throw_internal in fact couldn't trap at all.
8941 So we should in fact delete the EH edges out of the block. */
8942 else
8943 purge_dead_edges (bb);
8947 /* We've possibly turned single trapping insn into multiple ones. */
8948 if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
8950 sbitmap blocks;
8951 blocks = sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block);
8952 sbitmap_ones (blocks);
8953 find_many_sub_basic_blocks (blocks);
8954 sbitmap_free (blocks);
8957 if (inserted)
8958 commit_edge_insertions ();
8960 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
8961 /* Verify that we didn't turn one trapping insn into many, and that
8962 we found and corrected all of the problems wrt fixups on the
8963 fallthru edge. */
8964 verify_flow_info ();
8965 #endif